blob: 93acf89e90a51688472c0beac8d7f087a165a9aa [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor3fc749d2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000041 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
43 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo));
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000045 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
46 if (E.isInvalid())
47 return ExprError();
48 return move(E);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000049}
50
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000051static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
52 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000053 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000054 bool CStyle,
55 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000056
57static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
58 QualType &ToType,
59 bool InOverloadResolution,
60 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
61 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000062static OverloadingResult
63IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
64 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
65 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
66 bool AllowExplicit);
67
68
69static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
70CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
71 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
72 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
73
74static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
75CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
76 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
77 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
78
79static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
80CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
81 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
82 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
83
84
85
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
87/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000088ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000089GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
90 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
91 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
92 ICC_Identity,
93 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
94 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
95 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +000096 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000097 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
98 ICC_Promotion,
99 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000100 ICC_Promotion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
105 ICC_Conversion,
106 ICC_Conversion,
107 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000109 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000110 ICC_Conversion,
111 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000112 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000113 ICC_Conversion
114 };
115 return Category[(int)Kind];
116}
117
118/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
119/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
120ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
121 static const ImplicitConversionRank
122 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
124 ICR_Exact_Match,
125 ICR_Exact_Match,
126 ICR_Exact_Match,
127 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000128 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000129 ICR_Promotion,
130 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000131 ICR_Promotion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000134 ICR_Conversion,
135 ICR_Conversion,
136 ICR_Conversion,
137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000139 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000140 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000141 ICR_Conversion,
142 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000143 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
144 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000145 ICR_Conversion,
146 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000147 };
148 return Rank[(int)Kind];
149}
150
151/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
152/// implicit conversion.
153const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000154 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "No conversion",
156 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
157 "Array-to-pointer",
158 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000159 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000160 "Qualification",
161 "Integral promotion",
162 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000163 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000164 "Integral conversion",
165 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000166 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 "Floating-integral conversion",
168 "Pointer conversion",
169 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000170 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000171 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000172 "Derived-to-base conversion",
173 "Vector conversion",
174 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000175 "Complex-real conversion",
176 "Block Pointer conversion",
177 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000178 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000179 };
180 return Name[Kind];
181}
182
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000183/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
184/// sequence to the identity conversion.
185void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
186 First = ICK_Identity;
187 Second = ICK_Identity;
188 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000189 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000190 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191 ReferenceBinding = false;
192 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000193 IsLvalueReference = true;
194 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
195 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000196 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000197 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000198 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000199}
200
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000201/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
202/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
203/// implicit conversions.
204ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
205 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
206 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
207 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
208 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
209 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
210 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
211 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
212 return Rank;
213}
214
215/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
216/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000217/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000218/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000219bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000220 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
221 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
222 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
223 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000224 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000225 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
226 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
227 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000228 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000229 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
230 return true;
231
232 return false;
233}
234
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000235/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
236/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
237/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
238/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000239bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000240StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000241isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000242 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000243 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000244
245 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
246 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
247 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
248 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
249 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
250
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000251 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000252 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000253 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
254
255 return false;
256}
257
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000258/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
259/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
260void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000261 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000262 bool PrintedSomething = false;
263 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000265 PrintedSomething = true;
266 }
267
268 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
269 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000270 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000271 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000272 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000273
274 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000275 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000276 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000277 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000278 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000279 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000280 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
285 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000286 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000287 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000288 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000289 PrintedSomething = true;
290 }
291
292 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000293 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000294 }
295}
296
297/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
298/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
299void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000300 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000301 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
302 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000303 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000304 }
Benjamin Kramer900fc632010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000305 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000306 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 After.DebugPrint();
309 }
310}
311
312/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
313/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
314void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000315 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000316 switch (ConversionKind) {
317 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 Standard.DebugPrint();
320 break;
321 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000322 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
324 break;
325 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000326 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000327 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000328 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000329 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000330 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000331 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000332 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000333 break;
334 }
335
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000336 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000337}
338
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000339void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
340 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
341}
342
343void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
344 conversions().~ConversionSet();
345}
346
347void
348AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
349 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
350 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
351 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
352}
353
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000354namespace {
355 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
356 // template parameter and template argument information.
357 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
358 TemplateParameter Param;
359 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
360 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
361 };
362}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000363
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000364/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
365/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
366OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000367static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
368 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000369 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
371 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
372 Result.Data = 0;
373 switch (TDK) {
374 case Sema::TDK_Success:
375 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000376 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
377 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000378 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000379
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000380 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000381 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000382 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
383 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000384
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000385 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000386 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000387 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
388 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000389 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
390 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
391 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
392 Result.Data = Saved;
393 break;
394 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000395
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000396 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000397 Result.Data = Info.take();
398 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000399
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000401 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000402 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000403 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000404
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000405 return Result;
406}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000407
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
409 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
410 case Sema::TDK_Success:
411 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
412 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000413 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
414 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000415 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000416 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000417
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000418 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000419 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000420 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000421 Data = 0;
422 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000423
424 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
425 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
426 Data = 0;
427 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000428
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000429 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000430 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000431 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
432 break;
433 }
434}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000435
436TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000437OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
438 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
439 case Sema::TDK_Success:
440 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000441 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
442 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000448 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000449
450 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000451 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000453
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000454 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000455 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000456 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
457 break;
458 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000459
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000460 return TemplateParameter();
461}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000462
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000463TemplateArgumentList *
464OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
465 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
466 case Sema::TDK_Success:
467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
468 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
469 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
470 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
471 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
472 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000473 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000474 return 0;
475
476 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
477 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000478
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000479 // Unhandled
480 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
482 break;
483 }
484
485 return 0;
486}
487
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000488const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
489 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
490 case Sema::TDK_Success:
491 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
492 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000493 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
494 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000495 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 return 0;
498
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000499 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000500 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000501 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000502
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000503 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000504 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000505 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
506 break;
507 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000508
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000509 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000510}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000511
512const TemplateArgument *
513OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
514 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
515 case Sema::TDK_Success:
516 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
517 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000518 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
519 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000520 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 return 0;
523
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000524 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000525 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
527
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000528 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000529 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
531 break;
532 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000534 return 0;
535}
536
537void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000538 inherited::clear();
539 Functions.clear();
540}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000541
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000543// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
544// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
545// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
546// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000547// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
548// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
549// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000550//
551// Example: Given the following input:
552//
553// void f(int, float); // #1
554// void f(int, int); // #2
555// int f(int, int); // #3
556//
557// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000558// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000559//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000560// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
561// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
562// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
563// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000564//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000565// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
566// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
567// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
568// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000569// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
570// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000571//
572// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
573// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
574// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
575// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000576Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000577Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
578 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000579 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000580 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000581 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
582
583 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
584 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
585 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
586
587 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
588 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
589 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
590
591 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
592 }
593
594 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
595 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
596 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
597 // function templates hide function templates with different
598 // return types or template parameter lists.
599 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
600 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
601
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000602 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000603 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
604 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
605 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
606 continue;
607 }
608
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000609 Match = *I;
610 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000611 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000612 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000613 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
614 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
615 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
616 continue;
617 }
618
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000619 Match = *I;
620 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000621 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000622 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000623 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
624 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
625 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000626 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
627 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000628 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
629 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
630 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
631 // template instantiation.
632 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000633 // (C++ 13p1):
634 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
635 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000636 Match = *I;
637 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000638 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000639 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000640
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000641 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000642}
643
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000644bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
645 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall7b492022010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000646 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
647 // overloads.
648 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
649 return false;
650
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000651 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
652 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
653
654 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
655 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
656 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
657 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
658 return true;
659
660 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
661 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
662 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
663
664 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
665 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
666 // in the signature, they are overloads.
667
668 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
669 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
670 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
671 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
672 return false;
673
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000674 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
675 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676
677 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
678 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
679 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
680 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
681 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
682 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000683 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000684 return true;
685
686 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
687 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
688 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
689 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
690 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
691 // signature.
692 //
693 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
694 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000695 //
696 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
697 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
698 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
700 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
701 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
702 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
703 return true;
704
705 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000706 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000707 //
708 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
709 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
710 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
711 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
712 // can be overloaded.
713 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
714 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
715 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
716 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000717 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000718 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
719 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
720 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
721 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
722 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
723 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000724 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
725 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
726 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
727 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000728 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
729 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
730 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
731 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
732 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000733
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000734 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000735 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000736
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000737 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
738 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000739}
740
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +0000741/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
742/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
743///
744/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
745/// an available function, false otherwise.
746bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
747 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
748}
749
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000750/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
751/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
752/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
753/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000754///
755/// void f(float f);
756/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
757///
758/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
759/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
760/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
761/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
762//
763/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
764/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
765/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
766/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
767/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000768///
769/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
770/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000771/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
772/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000773///
774/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
775/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
776/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000777static ImplicitConversionSequence
778TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
779 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000780 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000781 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000782 bool CStyle,
783 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000784 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000785 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000786 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000787 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000788 return ICS;
789 }
790
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000791 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000792 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000793 return ICS;
794 }
795
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000796 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
797 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
798 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
799 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
800 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
801 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
802 // called for those cases.
803 QualType FromType = From->getType();
804 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000805 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
806 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 ICS.setStandard();
808 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
809 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
810 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000811
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000812 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
813 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
814 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
815 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
816 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000817
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000818 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000819 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000820 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000821
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000822 return ICS;
823 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000824
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000825 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
826 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
827 // we can perform.
828 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000829 return ICS;
830 }
831
832 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000833 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
834 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000835 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000836 AllowExplicit);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000837
838 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000839 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor396b7cd2008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000840 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
841 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
842 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
843 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
844 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
845 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
846 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000847 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor396b7cd2008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000848 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000849 QualType FromCanon
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000850 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
851 QualType ToCanon
852 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000853 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000854 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000855 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
856 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000857 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor396b7cd2008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000858 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000859 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000860 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000861 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor2b1e0032009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000862 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor396b7cd2008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000863 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
864 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000866
867 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
868 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
869 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
870 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
871 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
872 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
873 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000874 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000875 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000876 }
John McCallcefd3ad2010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000877 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000878 ICS.setAmbiguous();
879 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
880 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
881 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
882 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
883 if (Cand->Viable)
884 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanianb1663d02009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000885 } else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000886 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanianb1663d02009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000887 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000888
889 return ICS;
890}
891
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000892ImplicitConversionSequence
893Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
894 bool SuppressUserConversions,
895 bool AllowExplicit,
896 bool InOverloadResolution,
897 bool CStyle,
898 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
899 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
900 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
901 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
902 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000903}
904
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000905/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000906/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000907/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
908/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
909/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000910ExprResult
911Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000912 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
913 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
914 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
915}
916
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000917ExprResult
918Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000919 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
920 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000921 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
922 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
923 = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
924 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
925
926
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000927 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
928 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
929 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000930 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000931 /*CStyle=*/false,
932 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000933 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
934}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000935
936/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000937/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +0000938bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
939 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000940 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
941 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000942
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000943 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
944 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
945 // - a pointer
946 // - a member pointer
947 // - a block pointer
948 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
949 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
950 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
951 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
952 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
953 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
954 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
955 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
956 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
957 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
958 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
959 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
960 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
961 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
962 } else {
963 return false;
964 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000965
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000966 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
967 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
968 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
969 return false;
970 }
971
972 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
973 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
974 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
975
976 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
977 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
978 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
979
980 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000981 return true;
982}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000983
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000984/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
985/// vector conversion.
986///
987/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
988/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000989static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
990 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000991 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
992 // conversion.
993 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
994 return false;
995
996 // Identical types require no conversions.
997 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
998 return false;
999
1000 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1001 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1002 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1003 // identity conversion.
1004 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1005 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001006
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001007 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001008 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001009 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1010 return true;
1011 }
1012 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001013
1014 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1015 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1016 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1017 // same size
1018 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1019 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001020 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1021 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001022 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1023 return true;
1024 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001025 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001026
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001027 return false;
1028}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001029
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001030/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1031/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1032/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1033/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1034/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1035/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1036/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1037/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001038static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1039 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001040 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001041 bool CStyle,
1042 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001043 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001044
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001045 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001046 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001047 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001048 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001049 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001050 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001051
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001052 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001053 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001054 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001055 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001056 return false;
1057
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001058 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001059 }
1060
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001061 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1062 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1063 // (C++ 4p1).
1064
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001065 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001066 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1067 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001068 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001069 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001070 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1071 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1072 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001073
1074 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1075 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1076 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1077 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1078 QualType resultTy;
1079 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001080 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001081 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1082 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1083 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1084 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001086
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001087 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1088 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1089 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1090 // expression.
1091 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1092 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1093 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1094 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1095 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1096 == UO_AddrOf &&
1097 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1098 const Type *ClassType
1099 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1100 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001101 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1102 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1103 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001104 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1105 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1106 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001107
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001108 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001109 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1110 FromType,
1111 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001112 } else {
1113 return false;
1114 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001115 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001116 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001117 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1118 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001119 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1120 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001121 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001122 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001123 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001124
1125 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1126 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001127 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1128 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001129 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1131 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001132 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001133
1134 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1135 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1136 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001137 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001138
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001139 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001141 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1144 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1145 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1146 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001147 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1148 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001149 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001150 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001151 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001153 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001154 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001155 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001156
1157 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1158 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1159 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001160 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001161 } else {
1162 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001163 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001164 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001165 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001166
1167 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1168 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1169 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1170 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001171 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1172 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001173 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001174 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001175 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001176 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1177 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001178 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001179 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001180 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001181 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001182 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001183 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001184 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001185 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001186 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001187 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001188 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001189 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1190 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001191 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1192 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1193 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1194 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1195 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1196 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1197 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1198 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1199 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001200 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001201 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001202 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001203 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001204 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001205 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001206 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001207 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1208 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001209 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1210 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001211 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1212 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1213 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001214 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001215 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1216 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1217 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001218 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001219 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001220 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001221 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001222 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001223 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001224 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001225 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001226 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1227 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1228 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1229 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001230 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1231 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001232 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001233 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001234 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001235 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001236 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001237 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001238 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001239 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001240 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001241 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1242 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001243 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1244 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001245 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001246 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001247 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001248 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001249 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1250 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001251 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1252 InOverloadResolution,
1253 SCS, CStyle)) {
1254 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1255 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001256 } else {
1257 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001258 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001259 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001260 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001261
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001262 QualType CanonFrom;
1263 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001264 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001265 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1266 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1267 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001268 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001269 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001270 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001271 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1272 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001273 } else {
1274 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001275 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1276
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001277 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001278 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1279 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1280 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001281 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1282 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001283 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001284 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian62ac5d02010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001285 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001286 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1287 || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001288 FromType = ToType;
1289 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1290 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001291 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001292 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001293
1294 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1295 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001296 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001297 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001298
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001299 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001300}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001301
1302static bool
1303IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1304 QualType &ToType,
1305 bool InOverloadResolution,
1306 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1307 bool CStyle) {
1308
1309 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1310 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1311 return false;
1312 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1313 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1314 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1315 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1316 itend = UD->field_end();
1317 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001318 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1319 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001320 ToType = it->getType();
1321 return true;
1322 }
1323 }
1324 return false;
1325}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001326
1327/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1328/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1329/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1330/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001331bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001332 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001333 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001334 if (!To) {
1335 return false;
1336 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001337
1338 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1339 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1340 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1341 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1342 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001343 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1344 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001345 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1346 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1347 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1348 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001349 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001350 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001351 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001352 }
1353
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001354 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1355 }
1356
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001357 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1358 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1359 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1360 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1361 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1362 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001363 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001364 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001365 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001366 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1367 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001368 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001369 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1370 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1371 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1372 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1373 return false;
1374
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001375 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001376 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregor5dde1602010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001377 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001378 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1379 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001380 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001381
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001382 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001383 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1384 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1385 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001386 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001387 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001388 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001389 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001390 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001391 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001392 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001393 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1394 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001395 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001396 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001397
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001398 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1399 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001400 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1401 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001402 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1403 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001404 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001405 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001406 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1407 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001408 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001409 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1410 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1411 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1412 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001413 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001414 }
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1419 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1420 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1421 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1422 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1423 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1424 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001425 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1426 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001427 using llvm::APSInt;
1428 if (From)
1429 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001430 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001431 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001432 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1433 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1434 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001435
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001436 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1437 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1438 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1439 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1440 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001441
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001442 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1443 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1444 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1445 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1446 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001447
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001448 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001449 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001450 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001451
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001452 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1453 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001454 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001455 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001456 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001457
1458 return false;
1459}
1460
1461/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1462/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1463/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001464bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001465 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1466 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001467 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1468 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001469 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1470 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1471 return true;
1472
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001473 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1474 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1475 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1476 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1477 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1478 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1479 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1480 return true;
1481 }
1482
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001483 return false;
1484}
1485
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001486/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1487///
1488/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1489/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001490/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001491bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001492 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001493 if (!FromComplex)
1494 return false;
1495
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001496 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001497 if (!ToComplex)
1498 return false;
1499
1500 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001501 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1502 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1503 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001504}
1505
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001506/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1507/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1508/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1509/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1510/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001511///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001512static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001513BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001514 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001515 ASTContext &Context,
1516 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001517 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1518 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1519 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001520
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001521 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1522 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001523 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001524
1525 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001526 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001527 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001528 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001529
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001530 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1531 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1532
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001533 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001534 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001535 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001536 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001537 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001538
1539 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1540 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001541 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1542 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001543 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1544 }
1545
1546 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001547 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1548 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001549
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001550 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1551 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1552 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001553}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001554
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001555static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001556 bool InOverloadResolution,
1557 ASTContext &Context) {
1558 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1559 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1560 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001561 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001562 return !InOverloadResolution;
1563
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001564 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1565 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1566 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001567}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001568
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001569/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1570/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1571/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1572/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1573/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1574/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001575///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001576/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1577/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1578/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1579/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1580/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1581/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001582/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1583/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1584/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001585bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001586 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001587 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001588 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001589 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001590 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1591 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001592 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001593
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001594 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1595 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001596 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001597 ConvertedType = ToType;
1598 return true;
1599 }
1600
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001601 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1602 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001603 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001604 ConvertedType = ToType;
1605 return true;
1606 }
1607 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1608 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001609 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001610 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001611 ConvertedType = ToType;
1612 return true;
1613 }
1614
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001615 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1616 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001617 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001618 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001619 ConvertedType = ToType;
1620 return true;
1621 }
1622
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001623 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001624 if (!ToTypePtr)
1625 return false;
1626
1627 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001628 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001629 ConvertedType = ToType;
1630 return true;
1631 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001632
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001633 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001634 // , including objective-c pointers.
1635 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001636 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1637 !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001638 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1639 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1640 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001641 ToType, Context);
1642 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001643 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001644 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001645 if (!FromTypePtr)
1646 return false;
1647
1648 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001649
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001650 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001651 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1652 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1653 return false;
1654
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001655 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1656 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1657 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001658 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1659 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001660 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001661 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001662 ToType, Context,
1663 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001664 return true;
1665 }
1666
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00001667 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
1668 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
1669 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1670 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1671 ToPointeeType,
1672 ToType, Context);
1673 return true;
1674 }
1675
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001676 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1677 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001678 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001679 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001680 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001681 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001682 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001683 return true;
1684 }
1685
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001686 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001687 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001688 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1689 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1690 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1691 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1692 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1693 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1694 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1695 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1696 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001697 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1698 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001699 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1700 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001701 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregor2685eab2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001702 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001703 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001704 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001705 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001706 ToType, Context);
1707 return true;
1708 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001709
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00001710 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1711 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1712 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1713 ToPointeeType,
1714 ToType, Context);
1715 return true;
1716 }
1717
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001718 return false;
1719}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001720
1721/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1722static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1723 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1724
1725 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1726 if (TQs == Qs)
1727 return T;
1728
1729 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1730 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1731
1732 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1733}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001734
1735/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1736/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1737/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001738bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001739 QualType& ConvertedType,
1740 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1741 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1742 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001743
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001744 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
1745 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
1746
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001747 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001748 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1749 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001750 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001751 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001752
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001753 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001754 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1755 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1756 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1757 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1758 return false;
1759
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001760 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001761 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001762 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001763 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001764 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001765 return true;
1766 }
1767 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001768 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001769 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001770 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001771 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001772 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001773 return true;
1774 }
1775 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1776 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1777 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001778 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1779 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1780 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1781 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1782 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1783 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001784 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001785 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1786 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001787 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001788 return true;
1789 }
1790
1791 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1792 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1793 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1794 // complain about it.
1795 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001796 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001797 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1798 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001799 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001800 return true;
1801 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001802 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001803 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001804 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001805 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001806 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001807 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001808 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001809 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001810 // to a block pointer type.
1811 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001812 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001813 return true;
1814 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001815 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001816 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001817 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001818 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001819 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001820 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001821 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001822 return true;
1823 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001824 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001825 return false;
1826
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001827 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001828 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001829 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001830 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1831 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001832 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1833 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001834 return false;
1835
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001836 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1837 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1838 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1839 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1840 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1841 // We always complain about this conversion.
1842 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001843 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001844 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001845 return true;
1846 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001847 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1848 // as in I* to id.
1849 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1850 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1851 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1852 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001853
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001854 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001855 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001856 return true;
1857 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001858
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001859 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001860 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1861 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1862 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001863 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001864 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001865 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001866 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001867 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1868 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1869 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1870 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1871 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1872 return false;
1873
1874 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1875 // function types are obviously different.
1876 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1877 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1878 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1879 return false;
1880
1881 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1882 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1883 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1884 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1885 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1886 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1887 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1888 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1889 HasObjCConversion = true;
1890 } else {
1891 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1892 return false;
1893 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001894
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001895 // Check argument types.
1896 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1897 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1898 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1899 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1900 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1901 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1902 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1903 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1904 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1905 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1906 HasObjCConversion = true;
1907 } else {
1908 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1909 return false;
1910 }
1911 }
1912
1913 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1914 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1915 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001916 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001917 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1918 return true;
1919 }
1920 }
1921
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001922 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001923}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001924
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001925/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
1926/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
1927///
1928/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
1929///
1930/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
1931///
1932/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
1933/// this conversion.
1934bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1935 QualType &ConvertedType) {
1936 if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
1937 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1938 return false;
1939
1940 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
1941 QualType ToPointee;
1942 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
1943 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
1944 else
1945 return false;
1946
1947 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
1948 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
1949 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
1950 !ToQuals.withoutObjCGLifetime().empty())
1951 return false;
1952
1953 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
1954 QualType FromPointee;
1955 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1956 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
1957 else
1958 return false;
1959
1960 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
1961 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
1962 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
1963 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
1964 return false;
1965
1966 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
1967 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
1968 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
1969 return false;
1970
1971 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
1972 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
1973 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
1974 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
1975
1976 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
1977 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
1978 bool IncompatibleObjC;
1979 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
1980 FromPointee = ToPointee;
1981 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
1982 IncompatibleObjC))
1983 return false;
1984
1985 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
1986 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
1987 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
1988 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
1989 return true;
1990}
1991
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001992bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1993 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1994 QualType ToPointeeType;
1995 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1996 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1997 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1998 else
1999 return false;
2000
2001 QualType FromPointeeType;
2002 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2003 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2004 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2005 else
2006 return false;
2007 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2008 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2009 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2010
2011 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2012 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2013 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2014 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2015
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002016 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2017 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002018
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002019 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002020 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002021
2022 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2023 // function types are obviously different.
2024 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2025 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2026 return false;
2027
2028 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2029 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2030 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2031 return false;
2032
2033 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002034 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2035 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002036 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2037 } else {
2038 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2039 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2040 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2041 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2042 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2043
2044 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2045 // OK exact match.
2046 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2047 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2048 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2049 return false;
2050 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2051 }
2052 else
2053 return false;
2054 }
2055
2056 // Check argument types.
2057 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2058 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2059 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2060 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2061 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2062 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2063 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2064 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2065 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2066 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2067 return false;
2068 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2069 } else
2070 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2071 return false;
2072 }
2073 ConvertedType = ToType;
2074 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002075}
2076
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002077/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2078/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2079/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2080/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002081bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002082 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002083 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2084 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
2085 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002086
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002087 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2088 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2089 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2090 QualType ToType = (*O);
2091 QualType FromType = (*N);
2092 if (ToType != FromType) {
2093 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2094 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth0ee93de2010-05-06 00:15:06 +00002095 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2096 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2097 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2098 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002099 continue;
2100 }
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002101 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2102 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002103 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002104 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
2105 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
2106 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002107 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002108 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002109 }
2110 }
2111 return true;
2112}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002113
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002114/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2115/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002116/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002117/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2118/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2119/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002120bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002121 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002122 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002123 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002124 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002125 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002126
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002127 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2128
Chandler Carruth88f0aed2011-04-09 07:32:05 +00002129 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2130 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2131 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2132 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
Chandler Carruthb6006692011-04-09 07:48:17 +00002133 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2134 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00002135
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002136 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2137 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002138 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2139 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002140
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002141 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2142 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002143 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2144 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002145 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2146 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002147 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002148 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002149 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002150
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002151 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002152 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002153 }
2154 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002156 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002157 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002158 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002159 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2160 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2161 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002162 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002163 return false;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002164 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002165 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002166
2167 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2168 // reasons.
2169 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2170 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2171
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002172 return false;
2173}
2174
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002175/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2176/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2177/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2178/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2179/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2180bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002181 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002182 bool InOverloadResolution,
2183 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002184 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002185 if (!ToTypePtr)
2186 return false;
2187
2188 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002189 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2190 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2191 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002192 ConvertedType = ToType;
2193 return true;
2194 }
2195
2196 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002197 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002198 if (!FromTypePtr)
2199 return false;
2200
2201 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2202 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2203 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2204 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002205
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002206 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2207 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2208 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002209 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2210 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2211 return true;
2212 }
2213
2214 return false;
2215}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002216
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002217/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2218/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002219/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002220/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2221/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2222/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002223bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002224 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002225 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002226 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002227 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002228 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002229 if (!FromPtrType) {
2230 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002231 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002232 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002233 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002234 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002235 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002236 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002237
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002238 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002239 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2240 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002241
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002242 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2243 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002244
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002245 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2246 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2247 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002248
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002249 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002250 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002251 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2252 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2253 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2254 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002255
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002256 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2257 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002258 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2259 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2260 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2261 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002262 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002263
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002264 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002265 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2266 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2267 << From->getSourceRange();
2268 return true;
2269 }
2270
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002271 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002272 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2273 Paths.front(),
2274 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002275
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002276 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002277 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002278 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002279 return false;
2280}
2281
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002282/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2283/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2284/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002285///
2286/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2287/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2288/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002289bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002290Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002291 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002292 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2293 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002294 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2295
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002296 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2297 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002298 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002299 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002300
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002301 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2302 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2303 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2304 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002305 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002306 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002307 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2308 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2309 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002310 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002311 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2312 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002313 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002314
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002315 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2316 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2317
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002318 // Objective-C ARC:
2319 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2320 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2321 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2322 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2323 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2324 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2325 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2326 } else {
2327 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2328 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2329 return false;
2330 }
2331 }
2332
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002333 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2334 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2335 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2336 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2337 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2338 }
2339
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002340 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2341 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002342 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002343 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002344
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002345 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2346 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002347 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002348 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002349 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002350
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002351 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2352 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002353 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002354 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002355 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002356
2357 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2358 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2359 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2360 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2361 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002362 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002363}
2364
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002365/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2366/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2367/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2368/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2369/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2370/// false and User is unspecified.
2371///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002372/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2373/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2374/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002375static OverloadingResult
2376IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2377 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2378 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2379 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002380 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2381 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2382
2383 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2384 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002385 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002386 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2387 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2388 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2389 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2390 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2391 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2392 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2393 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002394 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002395 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002396 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002397 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2398
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00002399 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2400 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2401 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2402 // to try to recover.
2403 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002404 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2405 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2406 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002407 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002408 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002409 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002410 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2411 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2412
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002413 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2414 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2415 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002416 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002417 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002418 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002419 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2420 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002421 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002422
Fariborz Jahanian52ab92b2009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002423 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssonfaccd722009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002424 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002425 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002426 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2427 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002428 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002429 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2430 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002431 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002432 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2433 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002434 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2435 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2436 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2437 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002438 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002439 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002440 }
2441 }
2442
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002443 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2444 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002445 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2446 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002447 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002448 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002449 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002450 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002451 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2452 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002453 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianb191e2d2009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002454 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002455 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002456 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002457 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2458 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002459 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2460 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2461 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2462
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002463 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2464 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002465 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2466 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002467 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002468 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002469
2470 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2471 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002472 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2473 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2474 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002475 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002476 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2477 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002478 }
2479 }
2480 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002481 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002482
2483 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002484 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002485 case OR_Success:
2486 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2487 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2488 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002489 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2490
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002491 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2492 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2493 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2494 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2495 // the argument of the constructor.
2496 //
2497 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2498 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2499 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2500 else {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002501 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002502 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002503 }
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002504 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor83eecbe2011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002505 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002506 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2507 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2508 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2509 return OR_Success;
2510 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2511 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002512 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2513
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002514 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2515 //
2516 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2517 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2518 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2519 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2520 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2521 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor83eecbe2011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002522 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002523 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002524
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002525 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2526 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2527 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2528 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2529 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2530 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2531 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2532 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2533 // 13.3.3.1).
2534 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2535 return OR_Success;
2536 } else {
2537 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian34acd3e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002538 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002539 }
2540
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002541 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2542 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2543 case OR_Deleted:
2544 // No conversion here! We're done.
2545 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002546
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002547 case OR_Ambiguous:
2548 return OR_Ambiguous;
2549 }
2550
Fariborz Jahanian34acd3e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002551 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002552}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002553
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002554bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002555Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002556 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002557 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002558 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002559 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002560 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002561 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2562 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2563 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2564 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2565 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2566 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2567 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2568 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2569 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002570 return false;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002571 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002572 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002573}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002574
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002575/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2576/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2577/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002578static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2579CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2580 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2581 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002582{
2583 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2584 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2585 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2586 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2587 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2588 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2589 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2590 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002591 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002592 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2593 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2594 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2595 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2596 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002597 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2599 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2600 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002601
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002602 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2603 // the same kind.
2604 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2605 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2606
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002607 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2608 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2609 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002610 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002611 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002612 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002613 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2614 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2615 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2616 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2617 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2618 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002619 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002620 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002621 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2622 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002623 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2624 }
2625
2626 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2627}
2628
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002629static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2630 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2631 Qualifiers Quals;
2632 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002633 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002634 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002635
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002636 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2637}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002638
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002639// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2640// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2641static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2642compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2643 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2644 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2645 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2646 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2647
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002648 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002649 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00002650 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2652 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2653 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002654
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002655 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2656 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2657 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2658 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2659 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2660 else
2661 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002662 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002663 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2664
2665 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2666 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2667 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2668 }
2669
2670 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2671 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2672 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2673 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2674
2675 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2676 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2677 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2678 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002679
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002680 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2681}
2682
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002683/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2684/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2685static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2686 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2687 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2688 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2689 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002690 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002691 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002692 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002693 // reference*.
2694 //
2695 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2696 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2697 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2698 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2699 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002700 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2701 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2702 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002703
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002704 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2705 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2706 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2707 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2708}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002709
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002710/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2711/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2712/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002713static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2714CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2715 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2716 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002717{
2718 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2719 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2720
2721 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2722 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2723 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2724 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2725 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002726 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002727 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002728 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002729
2730 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2731 // defined below), or, if not that,
2732 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2733 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2734 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2735 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2736 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2737 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002738
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002739 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2740 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2741 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002742
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2744 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2745 // that is such a conversion.
2746 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2747 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2748 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2749 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2750
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002751 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2752 //
2753 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002754 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2755 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2756 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002757 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002758 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002759 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002760 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002761 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2762 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2763 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002764 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2765 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002766 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2767 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2768 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002769 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002770 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002771 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002772 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
2773 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002774 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2775 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2776 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002777 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2778 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002779
2780 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2781 // conversion, if we need to.
2782 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002783 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002784 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002785 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002786
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002787 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2788 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002789
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002790 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002791 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002792 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002793 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2794
2795 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2796 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00002797 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
2798 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2799 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
2800 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2801 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
2802 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
2803 FromObjCPtr2);
2804 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
2805 FromObjCPtr1);
2806 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
2807 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2808 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2809 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002810 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002811 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002812
2813 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2814 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002815 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002816 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002817 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002818
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002819 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002820 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2821 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2822 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2823 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2824 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002825
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002826 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2827 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2828 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2829 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2830 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2831 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002832 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2833 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002834 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2835 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002836 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002837 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2838 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002839 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002840 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
2841 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
2842 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
2843 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
2844 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
2845 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2846 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2847 }
2848
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002849 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2850 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002851 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002852 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002853 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002854 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002855 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2856 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2857 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002858 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002859 }
2860 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002861
2862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2863}
2864
2865/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2866/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002867/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2868ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002869CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2870 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2871 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002872 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002873 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2874 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2875 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2876 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2877 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2878 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2879 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2880 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2881
2882 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2883 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002884 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2885 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002886 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2887 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002888 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002889 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2890 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002891
2892 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2893 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002894 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002895 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2896
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002897 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2898 // for comparison.
2899 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002900 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002901 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002902 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002903
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002904 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002905 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002906
2907 // Objective-C++ ARC:
2908 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
2909 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
2910 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
2911 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
2912 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2913 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2914 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2915 }
2916
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002917 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002918 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2919 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2920 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002921 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002922 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2923 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2924 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2925 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2926 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2927 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2928 // about how the sequences rank.
2929 ;
2930 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2931 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2932 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2933 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2934 // qualifiers.
2935 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002936
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002937 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2938 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2939 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2940 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2941 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2942 // qualifiers.
2943 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002944
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002945 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2946 } else {
2947 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2948 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2949 }
2950
2951 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002952 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002953 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002954 }
2955
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002956 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2957 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2958 switch (Result) {
2959 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002960 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002961 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2962 break;
2963
2964 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2965 break;
2966
2967 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002968 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002969 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2970 break;
2971 }
2972
2973 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002974}
2975
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002976/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2977/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002978/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2979/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2980/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002981ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002982CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2983 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2984 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002985 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002986 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002987 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002988 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002989
2990 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2991 // conversion, if we need to.
2992 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002993 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002994 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002995 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002996
2997 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002998 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2999 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3000 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3001 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003002
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003003 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003004 //
3005 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3006 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003007 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003008 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003009 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003010 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3011 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3012 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3013 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003014 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003015 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003016 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003017 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003018 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003019 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003020 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003021 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003022
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003023 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003024 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003025 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003026 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003027 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003028 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3029 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003030
3031 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3032 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003033 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003034 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003035 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003036 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003037 }
3038 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3039 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3040 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3041 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3042 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3043 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3044 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3045 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3046 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3047 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3048
3049 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3050 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3051 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3052 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3053 // Objective-C pointer types.
3054 bool FromAssignLeft
3055 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3056 bool FromAssignRight
3057 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3058 bool ToAssignLeft
3059 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3060 bool ToAssignRight
3061 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3062
3063 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3064 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3065 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3066 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3067 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3068 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3069 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3070 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3071
3072 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3073 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3074 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3075 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3076 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3077 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3078
3079 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3080 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3081 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3082 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3083 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3084 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3085 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3086 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3087
3088 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3089 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3090 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3091 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3092 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3093 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003094
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003095 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3096 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3097 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3098 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3099 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3100 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3101
3102 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3103 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3104 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3105 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3106 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003107 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003108 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003109
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003110 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003111 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3112 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3113 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003114 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003115 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003116 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003117 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003118 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003119 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003120 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003121 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3122 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3123 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3124 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3125 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3126 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3127 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3128 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3129 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003130 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003131 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003132 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003133 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003134 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003135 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3136 }
3137 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3138 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003139 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003140 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003141 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003142 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3143 }
3144 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003145
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003146 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003147 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003148 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3149 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3150 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003151 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3152 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3153 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003154 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003155 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003156 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3157 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003158
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003159 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003160 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3161 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3162 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003163 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3164 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3165 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003166 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003167 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003168 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3169 }
3170 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003171
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003172 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3173}
3174
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003175/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3176/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3177/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3178/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3179/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3180/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3181/// type being initialized.
3182Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3183Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3184 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003185 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003186 bool &ObjCConversion,
3187 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003188 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3189 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3190 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3191
3192 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3193 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3194 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3195 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3196 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3197
3198 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3199 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3200 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3201 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003202 DerivedToBase = false;
3203 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003204 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003205 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3206 // Nothing to do.
3207 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003208 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3209 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003210 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3211 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3212 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3213 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003214 else
3215 return Ref_Incompatible;
3216
3217 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3218 // least).
3219
3220 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3221 // for comparison.
3222 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3223 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3224 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3225 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3226
3227 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3228 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3229 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3230 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3231 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3232 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3233 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003234 //
3235 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3236 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3237 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3238 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003239 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3240 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3241 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3242 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3243 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3244 }
3245
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003246 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003247 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003248 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003249 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3250 else
3251 return Ref_Related;
3252}
3253
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003254/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003255/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3256static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003257FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3258 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3259 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3260 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003261 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3262 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3263 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3264
3265 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3266 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3267 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3268 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3269 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3270 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3271 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3272 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3273 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3274
3275 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3276 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3277 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3278 if (ConvTemplate)
3279 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3280 else
3281 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3282
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003283 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003284 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3285 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3286 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003287
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003288 if (AllowRvalues) {
3289 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3290 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003291 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003292 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003293 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3294 DeclLoc,
3295 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3296 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3297 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003298 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003299 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003300 continue;
3301 } else {
3302 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3303 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3304 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3305
3306 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3307 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3308 if (!RefType ||
3309 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3310 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3311 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003312 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003313
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003314 if (ConvTemplate)
3315 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003316 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003317 else
3318 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003319 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003320 }
3321
3322 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003323 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003324 case OR_Success:
3325 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3326 //
3327 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3328 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3329 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3330 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3331 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3332 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3333 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3334 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3335 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3336 return false;
3337
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003338 if (Best->Function)
3339 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003340 ICS.setUserDefined();
3341 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3342 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3343 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
Douglas Gregor83eecbe2011-01-20 01:32:05 +00003344 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003345 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3346 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3347 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3348 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3349 return true;
3350
3351 case OR_Ambiguous:
3352 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3353 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3354 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3355 if (Cand->Viable)
3356 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3357 return true;
3358
3359 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3360 case OR_Deleted:
3361 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3362 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3363 return false;
3364 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003365
Eric Christopher1c3d5022010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003366 return false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003367}
3368
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003369/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3370/// initialization.
3371static ImplicitConversionSequence
3372TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3373 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3374 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003375 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003376 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3377
3378 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3379 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3380 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3381
3382 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3383 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3384
3385 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3386 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3387 // type of the resulting function.
3388 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3389 DeclAccessPair Found;
3390 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3391 false, Found))
3392 T2 = Fn->getType();
3393 }
3394
3395 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3396 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3397 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003398 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003399 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003400 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003401 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003402 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003403 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003404
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003405
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003406 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003407 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3408 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3409
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003410 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003411 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003412 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3413 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3414 //
3415 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3416 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3417 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003418 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003419 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3420 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3421 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3422 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3423 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3424 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3425 ICS.setStandard();
3426 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003427 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3428 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3429 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003430 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3431 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3432 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3433 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3434 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3435 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3436 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003437 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3438 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3439 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003440 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003441 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003442 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003443
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003444 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3445 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3446 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3447 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003448 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003449 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003450
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003451 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3452 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3453 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3454 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3455 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3456 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3457 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3458 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003459 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003460 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003461 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3462 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3463 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003464 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003465 }
3466 }
3467
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003468 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3469 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003470 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003471 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003472 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3473 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3474 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3475 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3476 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3477 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3478 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003479 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3480 // go together.
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003481 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003482 return ICS;
3483
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003484 // -- If the initializer expression
3485 //
3486 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003487 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003488 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3489 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3490 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3491 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3492 ICS.setStandard();
3493 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003494 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003495 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3496 : ICK_Identity;
3497 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3498 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3499 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3500 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3501 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3502 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3503 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3504 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3505 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3506 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3507 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003508 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3509 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003510 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003511 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3512 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003513 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003514 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003515 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003516 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003517 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003518 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003519
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003520 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3521 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003522 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3523 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003524 // "cv3 T3",
3525 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003526 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003527 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003528 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003529 // class subobject).
3530 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003531 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003532 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3533 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3534 AllowExplicit)) {
3535 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3536 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3537 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3538 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003539 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003540 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3541 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3542
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003543 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003544 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003545
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003546 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3547 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3548 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3549 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3550 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3551 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3552 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3553 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3554 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3555 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3556 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3557 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003558 //
3559 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
3560 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
3561 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
3562 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
3563 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3564 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3565 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3566 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3567 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
3568 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003569 }
3570
3571 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3572 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3573 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3574 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3575 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3576 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3577 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3578 return ICS;
3579
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003580 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3581 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3582 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3583 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3584 return ICS;
3585
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003586 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003587 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3588 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3589 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3590 // underlying type of the reference according to
3591 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3592 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3593 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3594 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3595 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003596 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3597 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003598 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003599 /*CStyle=*/false,
3600 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003601
3602 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3603 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3604 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003605 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3606 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3607 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003608 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003609 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003610 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3611 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003612 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3613 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3614 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003615 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003616 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003617 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003618
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003619 return ICS;
3620}
3621
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003622/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3623/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3624/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3625/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003626/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003627/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003628static ImplicitConversionSequence
3629TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003630 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003631 bool InOverloadResolution,
3632 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003633 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003634 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003635 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3636 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003637 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003638
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003639 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3640 SuppressUserConversions,
3641 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003642 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003643 /*CStyle=*/false,
3644 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003645}
3646
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003647/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3648/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3649/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003650static ImplicitConversionSequence
3651TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003652 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003653 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3654 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3655 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003656 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3657 // const volatile object.
3658 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3659 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003660 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003661
3662 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3663 // to exit early.
3664 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003665
3666 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003667 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003668 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003669 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3670
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003671 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3672 // better have an lvalue.
3673 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3674 }
3675
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003676 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003677
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003678 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003679 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003680 // parameter is
3681 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003682 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3683 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3684 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003685 // ref-qualifier
3686 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003687 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003688 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3689 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003690 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003691 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003692 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3693 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3694 // non-constant references.
3695
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003696 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003697 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003698 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003699 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003700 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003701 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3702 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003703 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003704 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003705
3706 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3707 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003708 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003709 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3710 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3711 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003712 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003713 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003714 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003715 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3716 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003717 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003718 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003719
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003720 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3721 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3722 case RQ_None:
3723 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3724 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003725
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003726 case RQ_LValue:
3727 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3728 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003729 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003730 ImplicitParamType);
3731 return ICS;
3732 }
3733 break;
3734
3735 case RQ_RValue:
3736 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3737 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003738 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003739 ImplicitParamType);
3740 return ICS;
3741 }
3742 break;
3743 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003744
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003745 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003746 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003747 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3748 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003749 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003750 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003751 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3752 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003753 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003754 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003755 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3756 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3757 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003758 return ICS;
3759}
3760
3761/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3762/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3763/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003764ExprResult
3765Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003766 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003767 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003768 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003769 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003770 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003771 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003772
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003773 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003774 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003775 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3776 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003777 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003778 } else {
3779 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3780 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003781 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003782 }
3783
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003784 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3785 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003786 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003787 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3788 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003789 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3790 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3791 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3792 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3793 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3794 if (CVR) {
3795 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3796 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3797 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3798 << From->getSourceRange();
3799 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3800 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003801 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003802 }
3803 }
3804
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003805 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003806 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003807 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003808 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003809
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003810 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3811 ExprResult FromRes =
3812 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3813 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3814 return ExprError();
3815 From = FromRes.take();
3816 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003817
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003818 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003819 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3820 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3821 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003822}
3823
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003824/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3825/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003826static ImplicitConversionSequence
3827TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregorc6dfe192010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003828 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003829 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003830 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3831 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003832 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003833 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003834 /*CStyle=*/false,
3835 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003836}
3837
3838/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3839/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003840ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003841 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003842 if (!ICS.isBad())
3843 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003844
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003845 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00003846 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3847 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003848 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003849 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003850}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003851
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003852/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3853/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003854static ImplicitConversionSequence
3855TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3856 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3857 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3858 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3859 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3860 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003861 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003862 /*CStyle=*/false,
3863 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003864}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003865
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003866/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3867/// of the expression From to 'id'.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003868ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003869 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003870 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003871 if (!ICS.isBad())
3872 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003873 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003874}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003875
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003876/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003877/// enumeration type.
3878///
3879/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3880/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3881/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3882///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003883/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3884/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003885///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003886/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3887///
3888/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3889/// have integral or enumeration type.
3890///
3891/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3892/// incomplete class type.
3893///
3894/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3895/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3896/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3897///
3898/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3899/// showing which conversion was picked.
3900///
3901/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3902/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3903///
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003904/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003905/// usable conversion function.
3906///
3907/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3908/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3909///
3910/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3911/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003912ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003913Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003914 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3915 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3916 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3917 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3918 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003919 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3920 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003921 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3922 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003923 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003924
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003925 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3926 QualType T = From->getType();
3927 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003928 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003929
3930 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3931
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003932 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003933 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3934 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3935 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3936 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3937 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003938 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003939 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003940
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003941 // We must have a complete class type.
3942 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003943 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003944
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003945 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3946 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3947 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3948 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3949 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003950
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003951 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003952 E = Conversions->end();
3953 I != E;
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003954 ++I) {
3955 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3956 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3957 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3958 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3959 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3960 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3961 else
3962 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3963 }
3964 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003965
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003966 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3967 case 0:
3968 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3969 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3970 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3971 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003972
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003973 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3974 // conversion; use it.
3975 QualType ConvTy
3976 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3977 std::string TypeStr;
3978 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003979
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003980 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3981 << T << ConvTy
3982 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3983 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3984 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3985 ")");
3986 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3987 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003988
3989 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003990 // explicit conversion function.
3991 if (isSFINAEContext())
3992 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003993
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003994 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003995 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
3996 if (Result.isInvalid())
3997 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003998
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003999 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004000 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004001
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004002 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
4003 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004004
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004005 case 1: {
4006 // Apply this conversion.
4007 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
4008 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004009
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004010 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4011 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
4012 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004013 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004014 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
4015 if (isSFINAEContext())
4016 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004017
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00004018 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
4019 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
4020 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004021
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004022 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004023 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004024 if (Result.isInvalid())
4025 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004026
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00004027 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004028 break;
4029 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004030
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004031 default:
4032 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
4033 << T << From->getSourceRange();
4034 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
4035 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
4036 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
4037 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4038 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
4039 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
4040 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004041 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004042 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004043
Douglas Gregoracb0bd82010-06-29 23:25:20 +00004044 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004045 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4046 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004047
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004048 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00004049}
4050
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004051/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004052/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
4053/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
4054/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004055///
4056/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
4057/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
4058/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004059void
4060Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004061 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004062 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004063 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00004064 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004065 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004066 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004067 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004068 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004069 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004070 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004071
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004072 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004073 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
4074 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
4075 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
4076 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
4077 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004078 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
4079 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
4080 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004081 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004082 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004083 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004084 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004085 return;
4086 }
4087 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
4088 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004089 }
4090
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00004091 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004092 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004093
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004094 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004095 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004096
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004097 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
4098 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
4099 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
4100 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
4101 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004102 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00004103 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00004104 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
4105 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00004106 return;
4107 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004108
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004109 // Add this candidate
4110 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4111 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004112 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004113 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004114 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004115 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004116 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004117 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004118
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004119 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4120
4121 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4122 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4123 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004124 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00004125 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004126 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004127 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004128 return;
4129 }
4130
4131 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4132 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4133 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4134 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4135 // exactly m parameters.
4136 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00004137 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004138 // Not enough arguments.
4139 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004140 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004141 return;
4142 }
4143
4144 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4145 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004146 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
4147 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4148 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4149 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4150 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4151 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4152 // parameter of F.
4153 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004154 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004155 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004156 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004157 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4158 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4159 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004160 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
4161 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004162 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004163 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004164 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004165 } else {
4166 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4167 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4168 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004169 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00004170 }
4171 }
4172}
4173
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004174/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
4175/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00004176void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004177 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4178 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4179 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00004180 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004181 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
4182 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004183 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004184 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004185 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004186 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004187 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004188 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
4189 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004190 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004191 SuppressUserConversions);
4192 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004193 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004194 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4195 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004196 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004197 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004198 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004199 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004200 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4201 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004202 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004203 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004204 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004205 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004206 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004207 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4208 SuppressUserConversions);
4209 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00004210 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004211}
4212
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004213/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
4214/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004215void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004216 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004217 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004218 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4219 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004220 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004221 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004222 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004223
4224 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
4225 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004226
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004227 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
4228 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4229 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004230 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4231 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004232 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004233 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004234 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004235 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004236 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004237 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004238 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004239 }
4240}
4241
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004242/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4243/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4244/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4245/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4246/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4247/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004248/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004249void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004250Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004251 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004252 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004253 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004254 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004255 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004256 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004257 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004258 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004259 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4260 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004261
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004262 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4263 return;
4264
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004265 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004266 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004267
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004268 // Add this candidate
4269 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4270 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004271 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004272 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004273 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004274 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004275 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004276
4277 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4278
4279 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4280 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4281 // list (8.3.5).
4282 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4283 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004284 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004285 return;
4286 }
4287
4288 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4289 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4290 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4291 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4292 // exactly m parameters.
4293 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4294 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4295 // Not enough arguments.
4296 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004297 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004298 return;
4299 }
4300
4301 Candidate.Viable = true;
4302 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4303
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004304 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004305 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4306 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4307 else {
4308 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4309 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004310 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004311 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4312 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004313 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004314 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004315 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004316 return;
4317 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004318 }
4319
4320 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4321 // arguments.
4322 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4323 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4324 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4325 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4326 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4327 // parameter of F.
4328 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004329 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004330 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004331 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004332 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4333 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4334 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004335 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004336 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004337 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004338 break;
4339 }
4340 } else {
4341 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4342 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4343 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004344 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004345 }
4346 }
4347}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004348
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004349/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4350/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4351/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004352void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004353Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004354 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004355 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004356 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004357 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004358 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004359 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004360 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004361 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004362 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4363 return;
4364
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004365 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004366 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004367 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004368 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004369 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4370 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4371 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4372 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4373 // functions.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004374 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004375 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4376 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004377 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004378 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004379 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4380 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4381 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4382 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4383 Candidate.Viable = false;
4384 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4385 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4386 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004387 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004388 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004389 Info);
4390 return;
4391 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004392
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004393 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4394 // deduction as a candidate.
4395 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004396 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004397 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004398 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004399 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4400 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004401}
4402
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004403/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4404/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4405/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004406void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004407Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004408 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004409 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004410 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4411 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004412 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004413 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4414 return;
4415
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004416 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004417 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004418 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004419 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004420 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4421 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4422 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4423 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4424 // functions.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004425 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004426 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4427 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004428 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004429 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004430 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4431 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004432 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004433 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4434 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004435 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004436 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4437 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004438 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004439 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004440 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004441 return;
4442 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004443
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004444 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4445 // deduction as a candidate.
4446 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004447 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004448 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004449}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004450
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004451/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004452/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004453/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004454/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004455/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4456/// conversion function produces).
4457void
4458Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004459 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004460 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004461 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4462 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004463 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4464 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004465 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004466 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4467 return;
4468
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004469 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004470 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004471
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004472 // Add this candidate
4473 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4474 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004475 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004476 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004477 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004478 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004479 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004480 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004481 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004482 Candidate.Viable = true;
4483 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004484 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004485
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004486 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004487 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4488 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004489 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004490 //
4491 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4492 // object parameter.
4493 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4494 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4495 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4496 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4497 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004498
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004499 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004500 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4501 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004502 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004503
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004504 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004505 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004506 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004507 return;
4508 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004509
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004510 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004511 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4512 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4513 QualType FromCanon
4514 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4515 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4516 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4517 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004518 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004519 return;
4520 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004521
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004522 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4523 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4524 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4525 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4526 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4527 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4528 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4529 // well-formed.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004530 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004531 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004532 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4533 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004534 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004535 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004536
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004537 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
4538 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004539 Candidate.Viable = false;
4540 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4541 return;
4542 }
4543
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004544 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004545
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004546 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004547 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4548 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00004549 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004550 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004551 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004552 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004553 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004554 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004555 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4556 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004557
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004558 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004559 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4560 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004561
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004562 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4563 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004564 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004565 // shall have exact match rank.
4566 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4567 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4568 Candidate.Viable = false;
4569 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4570 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004571
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004572 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4573 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4574 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4575 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4576 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004577 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004578 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4579 Candidate.Viable = false;
4580 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4581 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004582 break;
4583
4584 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4585 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004586 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004587 break;
4588
4589 default:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004590 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004591 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4592 }
4593}
4594
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004595/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4596/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4597/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4598/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4599/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004600void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004601Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004602 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004603 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004604 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4605 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4606 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4607 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4608
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004609 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4610 return;
4611
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004612 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004613 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4614 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004615 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004616 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004617 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4618 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4619 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4620 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4621 Candidate.Viable = false;
4622 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4623 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4624 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004625 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004626 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004627 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004628 return;
4629 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004630
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004631 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4632 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4633 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004634 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004635 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004636}
4637
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004638/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4639/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4640/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4641/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4642/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4643void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004644 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004645 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004646 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004647 Expr *Object,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004648 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004649 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004650 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4651 return;
4652
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004653 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004654 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004655
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004656 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4657 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004658 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004659 Candidate.Function = 0;
4660 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4661 Candidate.Viable = true;
4662 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004663 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004664 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004665 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004666
4667 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4668 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004669 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004670 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004671 Object->Classify(Context),
4672 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004673 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004674 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004675 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004676 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004677 return;
4678 }
4679
4680 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4681 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4682 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004683 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004684 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004685 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004686 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004687 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction
Douglas Gregor83eecbe2011-01-20 01:32:05 +00004688 = FoundDecl.getDecl();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004689 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004690 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4691 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4692
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004693 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004694 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4695
4696 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4697 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4698 // list (8.3.5).
4699 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4700 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004701 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004702 return;
4703 }
4704
4705 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4706 // we have enough arguments.
4707 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4708 // Not enough arguments.
4709 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004710 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004711 return;
4712 }
4713
4714 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4715 // arguments.
4716 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4717 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4718 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4719 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4720 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4721 // parameter of F.
4722 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004723 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004724 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004725 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004726 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4727 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4728 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004729 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004730 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004731 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004732 break;
4733 }
4734 } else {
4735 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4736 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4737 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004738 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004739 }
4740 }
4741}
4742
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004743/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4744/// member functions.
4745///
4746/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4747/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4748/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4749/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4750/// [over.match.oper]).
4751void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4752 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4753 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4754 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4755 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004756 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4757
4758 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4759 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4760 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4761 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4762 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4763 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4764 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4765 // constructed as follows:
4766 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004767
4768 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4769 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4770 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4771 // empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004772 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004773 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004774 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004775 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004776
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004777 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4778 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4779 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4780
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004781 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004782 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4783 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004784 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004785 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004786 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004787 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004788 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004789 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004790}
4791
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004792/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4793/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4794/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004795/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4796/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004797/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4798/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4799/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004800void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004801 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004802 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004803 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4804 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004805 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004806 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004807
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004808 // Add this candidate
4809 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4810 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004811 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004812 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004813 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004814 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004815 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4816 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4817 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4818
4819 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4820 // arguments.
4821 Candidate.Viable = true;
4822 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004823 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004824 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004825 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4826 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4827 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4828 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4829 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4830 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004831 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004832 //
4833 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4834 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4835 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4836 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004837 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004838 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004839 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004840 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4841 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004842 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004843 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004844 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004845 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004846 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4847 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4848 getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004849 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004850 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004851 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004852 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004853 break;
4854 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004855 }
4856}
4857
4858/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4859/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4860/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4861/// enumeration types.
4862class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4863 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004864 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004865
4866 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4867 /// built-in candidates.
4868 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4869
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004870 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4871 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4872 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4873
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004874 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4875 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4876 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4877
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004878 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004879 /// candidates.
4880 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004881
4882 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4883 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4884
4885 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4886 /// were present in the candidate set.
4887 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4888
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00004889 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
4890 /// candidate set.
4891 bool HasNullPtrType;
4892
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004893 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4894 /// candidate type set.
4895 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004896
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004897 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4898 ASTContext &Context;
4899
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004900 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4901 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004902 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004903
4904public:
4905 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004906 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004907
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004908 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004909 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4910 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00004911 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004912 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4913 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004914
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004915 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004916 SourceLocation Loc,
4917 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004918 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4919 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004920
4921 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4922 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4923
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004924 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004925 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4926
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004927 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4928 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4929
4930 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4931 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4932
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004933 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4934 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4935
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004936 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004937 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004938
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004939 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4940 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004941
4942 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4943 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00004944 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004945};
4946
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004947/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004948/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4949/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4950/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4951/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4952/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4953/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004954///
4955/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004956bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004957BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4958 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004959
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004960 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004961 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004962 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004963
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004964 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004965 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004966 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004967 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004968 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004969 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004970 buildObjCPtr = true;
4971 }
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004972 else
4973 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4974 }
4975 else
4976 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004977
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004978 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4979 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4980 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4981 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4982 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4983 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004984 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor89c49f02009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004985 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahaniand411b3f2009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004986 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004987 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4988 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004989
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004990 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4991 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4992 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004993 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4994 // in the types.
4995 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4996 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004997 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004998 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4999 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
5000 else
5001 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005002 }
5003
5004 return true;
5005}
5006
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005007/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
5008/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5009/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5010/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5011/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5012/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5013/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005014///
5015/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005016bool
5017BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
5018 QualType Ty) {
5019 // Insert this type.
5020 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
5021 return false;
5022
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005023 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5024 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005025
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005026 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00005027 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5028 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5029 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5030 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5031 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5032 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005033 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
5034
5035 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
5036 // qualifiers.
5037 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
5038 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5039 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005040
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005041 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005042 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
5043 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005044 }
5045
5046 return true;
5047}
5048
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005049/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
5050/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005051/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
5052/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005053/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
5054/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
5055/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
5056/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005057void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005058BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00005059 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005060 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005061 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5062 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005063 // Only deal with canonical types.
5064 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
5065
5066 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
5067 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005068 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005069 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
5070
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00005071 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
5072 if (Ty->isArrayType())
5073 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
5074
5075 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005076 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005077
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005078 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
5079 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
5080 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
5081
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005082 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
5083 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
5084 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
5085
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00005086 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
5087 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
5088 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005089 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
5090 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005091 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005092 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005093 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
5094 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
5095 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
5096 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005097 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005098 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00005099 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005100 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005101 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
5102 // extension.
5103 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005104 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005105 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
5106 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005107 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
5108 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
5109 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
5110 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005111
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005112 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
5113 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
5114 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5115 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
5116 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
5117 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5118 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5119 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005120
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005121 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
5122 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
5123 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
5124 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005125
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005126 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5127 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
5128 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
5129 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005130 }
5131 }
5132 }
5133}
5134
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005135/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
5136/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
5137/// given type to the candidate set.
5138static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
5139 QualType T,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005140 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005141 unsigned NumArgs,
5142 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5143 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005144
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005145 // T& operator=(T&, T)
5146 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5147 ParamTypes[1] = T;
5148 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5149 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005150
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005151 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
5152 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005153 ParamTypes[0]
5154 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005155 ParamTypes[1] = T;
5156 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005157 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005158 }
5159}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005160
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00005161/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
5162/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005163static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
5164 Qualifiers VRQuals;
5165 const RecordType *TyRec;
5166 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
5167 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00005168 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005169 else
5170 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5171 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00005172 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005173 VRQuals.addVolatile();
5174 VRQuals.addRestrict();
5175 return VRQuals;
5176 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005177
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005178 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00005179 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
5180 return VRQuals;
5181
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00005182 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00005183 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005184
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00005185 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00005186 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00005187 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5188 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5189 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5190 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005191 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
5192 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
5193 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
5194 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
5195 // as see them.
5196 bool done = false;
5197 while (!done) {
5198 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5199 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005200 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005201 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
5202 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
5203 else
5204 done = true;
5205 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
5206 VRQuals.addVolatile();
5207 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
5208 VRQuals.addRestrict();
5209 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
5210 return VRQuals;
5211 }
5212 }
5213 }
5214 return VRQuals;
5215}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005216
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005217namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005218
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005219/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
5220/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
5221/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
5222/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
5223class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005224 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
5225 Sema &S;
5226 Expr **Args;
5227 unsigned NumArgs;
5228 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005229 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005230 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005231 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005232
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005233 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
5234 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005235 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
5236 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005237 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
5238 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
5239 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
5240 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
5241 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
5242 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
5243 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
5244
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005245 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5246 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5247 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5248 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5249 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5250 // Start of promoted types.
5251 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5252 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5253 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005254
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005255 // Start of integral types.
5256 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5257 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5258 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5259 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5260 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5261 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5262 // End of promoted types.
5263
5264 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5265 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5266 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5267 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5268 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5269 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5270 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5271 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5272 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5273 // End of integral types.
5274 // FIXME: What about complex?
5275 };
5276 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5277 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005278
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005279 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5280 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5281 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5282 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5283 // The rules are basically:
5284 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5285 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5286 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5287 // - use the larger type
5288 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5289 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5290 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5291 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5292 // better not to make any assumptions).
5293 enum PromotedType {
5294 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5295 };
5296 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5297 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5298 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5299 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5300 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5301 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5302 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5303 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5304 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5305 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5306 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5307 };
5308
5309 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5310 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5311 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5312
5313 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005314 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005315
5316 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5317 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005318 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5319 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005320 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5321 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5322
5323 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5324 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5325 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5326
5327 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5328 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5329 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5330 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5331 }
5332
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005333 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5334 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005335 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5336 bool HasVolatile) {
5337 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5338 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5339 S.Context.IntTy
5340 };
5341
5342 // Non-volatile version.
5343 if (NumArgs == 1)
5344 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5345 else
5346 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5347
5348 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5349 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5350 if (HasVolatile) {
5351 ParamTypes[0] =
5352 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5353 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5354 if (NumArgs == 1)
5355 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5356 else
5357 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5358 }
5359 }
5360
5361public:
5362 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5363 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5364 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005365 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005366 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005367 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5368 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5369 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005370 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5371 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005372 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5373 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5374 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005375 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005376 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005377 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5378 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005379 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005380 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5381 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005382 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005383 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5384 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005385 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5386 }
5387
5388 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5389 //
5390 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5391 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5392 // functions of the form
5393 //
5394 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5395 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5396 //
5397 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5398 //
5399 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5400 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5401 // candidate operator functions of the form
5402 //
5403 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5404 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5405 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005406 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5407 return;
5408
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005409 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5410 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5411 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005412 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005413 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5414 }
5415 }
5416
5417 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5418 //
5419 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5420 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5421 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5422 //
5423 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5424 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5425 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5426 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5427 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5428 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5429 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5430 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5431 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5432 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005433 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005434 continue;
5435
5436 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5437 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5438 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5439 }
5440 }
5441
5442 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5443 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5444 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5445 //
5446 // T& operator*(T*);
5447 //
5448 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005449 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005450 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005451 // T& operator*(T*);
5452 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5453 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5454 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5455 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5456 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5457 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5458 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005459 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5460 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005461
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005462 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5463 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5464 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005465
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005466 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5467 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5468 }
5469 }
5470
5471 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5472 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5473 // operator functions of the form
5474 //
5475 // T operator+(T);
5476 // T operator-(T);
5477 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005478 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5479 return;
5480
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005481 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5482 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005483 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005484 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5485 }
5486
5487 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5488 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5489 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5490 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5491 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5492 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5493 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5494 }
5495 }
5496
5497 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5498 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5499 // the form
5500 //
5501 // T* operator+(T*);
5502 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5503 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5504 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5505 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5506 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5507 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5508 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5509 }
5510 }
5511
5512 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5513 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5514 // operator functions of the form
5515 //
5516 // T operator~(T);
5517 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005518 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5519 return;
5520
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005521 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5522 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005523 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005524 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5525 }
5526
5527 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5528 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5529 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5530 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5531 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5532 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5533 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5534 }
5535 }
5536
5537 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5538 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5539 // functions of the form
5540 //
5541 // bool operator==(T,T);
5542 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5543 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5544 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5545 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5546
5547 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5548 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5549 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5550 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5551 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5552 ++MemPtr) {
5553 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5554 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5555 continue;
5556
5557 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5558 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5559 CandidateSet);
5560 }
5561 }
5562 }
5563
5564 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5565 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005566 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
5567 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005568 //
5569 // bool operator<(T, T);
5570 // bool operator>(T, T);
5571 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5572 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5573 // bool operator==(T, T);
5574 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005575 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5576 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5577 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5578 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5579 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5580 // functions.
5581 //
5582 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5583 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5584 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5585 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5586 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5587 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5588 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5589 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5590 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5591
5592 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5593 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5594 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5595 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5596 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5597 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5598 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5599 continue;
5600
5601 QualType FirstParamType =
5602 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5603 QualType SecondParamType =
5604 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5605
5606 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5607 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5608 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5609 continue;
5610
5611 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5612 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5613 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5614 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5615 }
5616 }
5617 }
5618
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005619 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5620 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5621
5622 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5623 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5624 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5625 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5626 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5627 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5628 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5629 continue;
5630
5631 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5632 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5633 CandidateSet);
5634 }
5635 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5636 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5637 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5638 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5639 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5640
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005641 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5642 // candidate exists.
5643 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5644 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5645 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005646 continue;
5647
5648 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005649 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5650 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005651 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00005652
5653 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
5654 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
5655 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
5656 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
5657 NullPtrTy))) {
5658 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
5659 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5660 CandidateSet);
5661 }
5662 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005663 }
5664 }
5665
5666 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5667 //
5668 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5669 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5670 //
5671 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5672 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5673 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5674 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5675 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5676 //
5677 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5678 //
5679 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5680 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5681 //
5682 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5683 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5684 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5685 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5686
5687 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5688 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5689 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5690 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5691 };
5692 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5693 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5694 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5695 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005696 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5697 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5698 continue;
5699
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005700 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5701 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5702 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5703 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5704 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5705 CandidateSet);
5706 }
5707 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5708 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5709 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5710 continue;
5711
5712 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5713 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5714 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5715 }
5716 }
5717 }
5718 }
5719
5720 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5721 //
5722 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5723 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5724 //
5725 // LR operator*(L, R);
5726 // LR operator/(L, R);
5727 // LR operator+(L, R);
5728 // LR operator-(L, R);
5729 // bool operator<(L, R);
5730 // bool operator>(L, R);
5731 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5732 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5733 // bool operator==(L, R);
5734 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5735 //
5736 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5737 // between types L and R.
5738 //
5739 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5740 //
5741 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5742 // candidate operator functions of the form
5743 //
5744 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5745 //
5746 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5747 // between types L and R.
5748 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5749 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005750 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5751 return;
5752
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005753 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5754 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5755 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5756 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005757 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5758 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005759 QualType Result =
5760 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005761 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005762 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5763 }
5764 }
5765
5766 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5767 // conditional operator for vector types.
5768 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5769 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5770 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5771 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5772 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5773 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5774 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5775 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5776 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5777 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5778 if (!isComparison) {
5779 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5780 Result = *Vec1;
5781 else
5782 Result = *Vec2;
5783 }
5784
5785 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5786 }
5787 }
5788 }
5789
5790 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5791 //
5792 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5793 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5794 //
5795 // LR operator%(L, R);
5796 // LR operator&(L, R);
5797 // LR operator^(L, R);
5798 // LR operator|(L, R);
5799 // L operator<<(L, R);
5800 // L operator>>(L, R);
5801 //
5802 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5803 // between types L and R.
5804 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005805 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5806 return;
5807
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005808 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5809 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5810 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5811 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005812 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5813 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005814 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5815 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005816 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005817 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5818 }
5819 }
5820 }
5821
5822 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5823 //
5824 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5825 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5826 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5827 //
5828 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5829 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5830 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5831 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5832
5833 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5834 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5835 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5836 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5837 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5838 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5839 continue;
5840
5841 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5842 CandidateSet);
5843 }
5844
5845 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5846 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5847 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5848 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5849 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5850 continue;
5851
5852 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5853 CandidateSet);
5854 }
5855 }
5856 }
5857
5858 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5859 //
5860 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5861 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5862 // of the form
5863 //
5864 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5865 //
5866 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5867 //
5868 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5869 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5870 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5871 //
5872 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5873 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5874 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5875 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5876 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5877
5878 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5879 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5880 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5881 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5882 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5883 if (isEqualOp)
5884 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005885 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5886 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005887
5888 // non-volatile version
5889 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5890 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5891 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5892 };
5893 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5894 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5895
5896 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5897 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5898 // volatile version
5899 ParamTypes[0] =
5900 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5901 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5902 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5903 }
5904 }
5905
5906 if (isEqualOp) {
5907 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5908 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5909 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5910 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5911 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5912 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5913 continue;
5914
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005915 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5916 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5917 *Ptr,
5918 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005919
5920 // non-volatile version
5921 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5922 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5923
5924 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5925 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5926 // volatile version
5927 ParamTypes[0] =
5928 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005929 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5930 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005931 }
5932 }
5933 }
5934 }
5935
5936 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5937 //
5938 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5939 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5940 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5941 // the form
5942 //
5943 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5944 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5945 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5946 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5947 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5948 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005949 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5950 return;
5951
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005952 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5953 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5954 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5955 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005956 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005957
5958 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5959 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005960 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005961 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5962 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5963
5964 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5965 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5966 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005967 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005968 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005969 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5970 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005971 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5972 }
5973 }
5974 }
5975
5976 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5977 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5978 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5979 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5980 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5981 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5982 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5983 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5984 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5985 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5986 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5987 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5988 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5989 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5990 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5991
5992 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5993 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5994 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5995 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005996 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5997 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005998 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5999 }
6000 }
6001 }
6002 }
6003
6004 // C++ [over.built]p22:
6005 //
6006 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
6007 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
6008 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6009 //
6010 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
6011 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
6012 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
6013 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
6014 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
6015 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
6016 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006017 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6018 return;
6019
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006020 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
6021 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6022 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
6023 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006024 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006025
6026 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6027 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006028 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006029 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6030 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6031 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006032 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006033 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
6034 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6035 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6036 CandidateSet);
6037 }
6038 }
6039 }
6040 }
6041
6042 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
6043 //
6044 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
6045 //
6046 // bool operator!(bool);
6047 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
6048 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
6049 void addExclaimOverload() {
6050 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
6051 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
6052 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6053 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
6054 }
6055 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
6056 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
6057 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6058 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6059 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
6060 }
6061
6062 // C++ [over.built]p13:
6063 //
6064 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
6065 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6066 //
6067 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6068 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
6069 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
6070 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
6071 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
6072 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
6073 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6074 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6075 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6076 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6077 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
6078 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006079 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6080 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006081
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006082 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6083
6084 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
6085 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6086 }
6087
6088 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6089 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6090 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6091 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6092 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
6093 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006094 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6095 continue;
6096
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006097 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6098
6099 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
6100 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 // C++ [over.built]p11:
6105 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
6106 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
6107 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
6108 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6109 //
6110 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
6111 //
6112 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
6113 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
6114 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6115 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6116 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6117 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6118 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
6119 QualType C1;
6120 QualifierCollector Q1;
6121 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
6122 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
6123 continue;
6124 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
6125 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
6126 // volatile/restrict type.
6127 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
6128 continue;
6129 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
6130 continue;
6131 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6132 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
6133 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
6134 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6135 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
6136 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
6137 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
6138 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
6139 break;
6140 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
6141 // build CV12 T&
6142 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
6143 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
6144 T.isVolatileQualified())
6145 continue;
6146 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
6147 T.isRestrictQualified())
6148 continue;
6149 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
6150 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6151 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6152 }
6153 }
6154 }
6155
6156 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
6157 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
6158 // therefore added as binary.
6159 //
6160 // C++ [over.built]p25:
6161 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
6162 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6163 //
6164 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
6165 //
6166 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
6167 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6168 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6169
6170 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6171 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6172 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6173 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6174 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6175 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6176 continue;
6177
6178 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6179 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6180 }
6181
6182 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6183 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6184 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6185 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6186 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6187 continue;
6188
6189 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6190 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6191 }
6192
6193 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
6194 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6195 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6196 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6197 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6198 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
6199 continue;
6200
6201 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6202 continue;
6203
6204 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
6205 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6206 }
6207 }
6208 }
6209 }
6210};
6211
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006212} // end anonymous namespace
6213
6214/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
6215/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
6216/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
6217/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
6218/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
6219void
6220Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6221 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6222 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6223 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006224 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
6225 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006226 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
6227 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006228 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6229 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00006230 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6231 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006232
6233 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
6234 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006235 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006236 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6237 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
6238 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
6239 OpLoc,
6240 true,
6241 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
6242 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
6243 Op == OO_PipePipe),
6244 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006245 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
6246 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
6247 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
6248 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
6249 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00006250 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006251
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006252 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
6253 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
6254 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
6255 return;
6256
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006257 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6258 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6259 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006260 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006261 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6262
6263 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006264 switch (Op) {
6265 case OO_None:
6266 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6267 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
6268 break;
6269
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006270 case OO_New:
6271 case OO_Delete:
6272 case OO_Array_New:
6273 case OO_Array_Delete:
6274 case OO_Call:
6275 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6276 break;
6277
6278 case OO_Comma:
6279 case OO_Arrow:
6280 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6281 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6282 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006283 break;
6284
6285 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006286 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006287 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006288 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006289
6290 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006291 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006292 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006293 } else {
6294 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6295 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6296 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006297 break;
6298
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006299 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006300 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006301 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6302 else
6303 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6304 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006305
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006306 case OO_Slash:
6307 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006308 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006309
6310 case OO_PlusPlus:
6311 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006312 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6313 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006314 break;
6315
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006316 case OO_EqualEqual:
6317 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006318 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006319 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006320
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006321 case OO_Less:
6322 case OO_Greater:
6323 case OO_LessEqual:
6324 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006325 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006326 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6327 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006328
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006329 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006330 case OO_Caret:
6331 case OO_Pipe:
6332 case OO_LessLess:
6333 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006334 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006335 break;
6336
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006337 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6338 if (NumArgs == 1)
6339 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6340 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6341 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6342 break;
6343
6344 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6345 break;
6346
6347 case OO_Tilde:
6348 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6349 break;
6350
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006351 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006352 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006353 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006354
6355 case OO_PlusEqual:
6356 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006357 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006358 // Fall through.
6359
6360 case OO_StarEqual:
6361 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006362 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006363 break;
6364
6365 case OO_PercentEqual:
6366 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6367 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6368 case OO_AmpEqual:
6369 case OO_CaretEqual:
6370 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006371 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006372 break;
6373
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006374 case OO_Exclaim:
6375 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006376 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006377
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006378 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006379 case OO_PipePipe:
6380 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006381 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006382
6383 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006384 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006385 break;
6386
6387 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006388 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006389 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006390
6391 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006392 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006393 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6394 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006395 }
6396}
6397
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006398/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6399/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6400///
6401/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6402/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6403/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6404/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006405void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006406Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006407 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006408 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006409 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006410 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006411 bool PartialOverloading,
6412 bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006413 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006414
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006415 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6416 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6417 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6418 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6419 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6420 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6421
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006422 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00006423 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
6424 StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006425
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006426 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006427 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6428 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6429 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006430 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006431 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006432 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006433 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006434 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006435
6436 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6437 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006438 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006439 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006440 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006441 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006442 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006443
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006444 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorc27d6c52010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006445 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006446 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006447 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006448 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006449 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006450 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006451}
6452
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006453/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6454/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006455bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006456isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006457 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6458 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006459 SourceLocation Loc,
6460 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006461 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6462 // functions.
6463 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6464 return Cand1.Viable;
6465 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6466 return false;
6467
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006468 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6469 //
6470 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6471 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6472 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6473 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6474 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6475 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6476 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006477
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006478 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006479 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6480 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006481 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006482 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6483 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6484 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006485 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006486 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6487 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006488 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6489 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6490 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6491 HasBetterConversion = true;
6492 break;
6493
6494 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6495 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6496 return false;
6497
6498 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6499 // Do nothing.
6500 break;
6501 }
6502 }
6503
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006504 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006505 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006506 if (HasBetterConversion)
6507 return true;
6508
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006509 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006510 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006511 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006512 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6513 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006514
6515 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6516 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6517 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006518 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006519 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006520 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006521 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006522 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6523 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6524 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006525 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006526 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006527 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006528 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006529 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006530
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006531 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6532 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6533 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6534 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6535 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6536 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006537 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006538 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006539 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006540 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6541 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006542 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6543 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6544 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6545 return true;
6546
6547 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6548 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6549 return false;
6550
6551 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6552 // Do nothing
6553 break;
6554 }
6555 }
6556
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006557 return false;
6558}
6559
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006560/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006561/// within an overload candidate set.
6562///
6563/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6564///
6565/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6566/// which overload resolution occurs.
6567///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006568/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006569/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6570///
6571/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006572OverloadingResult
6573OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006574 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006575 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006576 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006577 Best = end();
6578 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6579 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006580 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006581 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006582 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006583 }
6584
6585 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006586 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006587 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6588
6589 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6590 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006591 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006592 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006593 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006594 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006595 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006596 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006597 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006598 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006599 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006600
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006601 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006602 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00006603 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
6604 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006605 return OR_Deleted;
6606
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006607 return OR_Success;
6608}
6609
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006610namespace {
6611
6612enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6613 oc_function,
6614 oc_method,
6615 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006616 oc_function_template,
6617 oc_method_template,
6618 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006619 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6620 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006621 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006622 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006623 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006624 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006625};
6626
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006627OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6628 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6629 std::string &Description) {
6630 bool isTemplate = false;
6631
6632 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6633 isTemplate = true;
6634 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6635 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6636 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006637
6638 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006639 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006640 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006641
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006642 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6643 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6644
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006645 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
6646 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
6647
6648 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
6649 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
6650
6651 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
6652 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
6653 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006654 }
6655
6656 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6657 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6658 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006659 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006660 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006661
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00006662 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6663 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
6664
Douglas Gregor3e9438b2010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006665 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006666 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006667 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6668 }
6669
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006670 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006671}
6672
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006673void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6674 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6675 if (!Ctor) return;
6676
6677 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6678 if (!Ctor) return;
6679
6680 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6681}
6682
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006683} // end anonymous namespace
6684
6685// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6686void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006687 std::string FnDesc;
6688 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6689 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6690 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006691 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006692}
6693
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006694//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6695// OverloadedExpr
6696void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6697 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6698
6699 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6700 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6701
6702 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6703 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6704 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6705 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6706 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6707 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6708 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6709 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6710 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6711 }
6712 }
6713}
6714
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006715/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6716/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6717/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006718void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6719 Sema &S,
6720 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6721 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6722 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6723 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006724 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006725 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6726 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006727 }
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006728}
6729
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006730namespace {
6731
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006732/// Try to find a fix for the bad conversion. Populate the ConvFix structure
6733/// on success. Produces the hints for the following cases:
6734/// - The user forgot to apply * or & operator to one or more arguments.
6735static bool TryToFixBadConversion(Sema &S,
6736 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv,
6737 OverloadCandidate::FixInfo &ConvFix) {
6738 assert(Conv.isBad() && "Only try to fix a bad conversion.");
6739
6740 const Expr *Arg = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6741 if (!Arg)
6742 return false;
6743
6744 // The conversion is from argument type to parameter type.
6745 const CanQualType FromQTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(Conv.Bad
6746 .getFromType());
6747 const CanQualType ToQTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(Conv.Bad.getToType());
6748 const SourceLocation Begin = Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin();
6749 const SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Arg->getSourceRange()
6750 .getEnd());
6751 bool NeedParen = true;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006752 if (isa<ParenExpr>(Arg) ||
6753 isa<DeclRefExpr>(Arg) ||
6754 isa<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Arg) ||
6755 isa<CallExpr>(Arg) ||
6756 isa<MemberExpr>(Arg))
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006757 NeedParen = false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006758 if (const UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(Arg))
6759 if (UO->isPostfix())
6760 NeedParen = false;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006761
6762 // Check if the argument needs to be dereferenced
6763 // (type * -> type) or (type * -> type &).
6764 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(FromQTy)) {
6765 // Try to construct an implicit conversion from argument type to the
6766 // parameter type.
6767 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Arg->getExprLoc(), FromPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
6768 VK_LValue);
6769 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6770 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
6771
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006772 OverloadFixItKind FixKind = OFIK_Dereference;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006773 if (!ICS.isBad()) {
6774 // Do not suggest dereferencing a Null pointer.
6775 if (Arg->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6776 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
6777 return false;
6778
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006779 if (const UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(Arg)) {
6780 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) {
6781 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(
6782 FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Arg->getSourceRange()));
6783 FixKind = OFIK_RemoveTakeAddress;
6784 }
6785 } else if (NeedParen) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006786 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Begin, "*("));
6787 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, ")"));
6788 } else {
6789 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Begin, "*"));
6790 }
6791 ConvFix.NumConversionsFixed++;
6792 if (ConvFix.NumConversionsFixed == 1)
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006793 ConvFix.Kind = FixKind;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006794 return true;
6795 }
6796 }
6797
6798 // Check if the pointer to the argument needs to be passed
6799 // (type -> type *) or (type & -> type *).
6800 if (isa<PointerType>(ToQTy)) {
6801 // Only suggest taking address of L-values.
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006802 if (!Arg->isLValue() || Arg->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006803 return false;
6804
6805 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Arg->getExprLoc(),
6806 S.Context.getPointerType(FromQTy), VK_RValue);
6807 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6808 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006809
6810 OverloadFixItKind FixKind = OFIK_TakeAddress;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006811 if (!ICS.isBad()) {
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006812
6813 if (const UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(Arg)) {
6814 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) {
6815 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(
6816 FixItHint::CreateRemoval(Arg->getSourceRange()));
6817 FixKind = OFIK_RemoveDereference;
6818 }
6819 } else if (NeedParen) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006820 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Begin, "&("));
6821 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, ")"));
6822 } else {
6823 ConvFix.Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Begin, "&"));
6824 }
6825 ConvFix.NumConversionsFixed++;
6826 if (ConvFix.NumConversionsFixed == 1)
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00006827 ConvFix.Kind = FixKind;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00006828 return true;
6829 }
6830 }
6831 return false;
6832}
6833
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006834void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6835 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6836 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006837 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6838 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6839
6840 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6841 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6842 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006843 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006844 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006845 if (I == 0)
6846 isObjectArgument = true;
6847 else
6848 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006849 }
6850
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006851 std::string FnDesc;
6852 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6853
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006854 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6855 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6856 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006857
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006858 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006859 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006860 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6861 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6862 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006863 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006864
6865 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6866 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6867 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6868 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006869 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006870 return;
6871 }
6872
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006873 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6874 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006875 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6876 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6877 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6878 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6879 else {
6880 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6881 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6882 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6883 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6884 }
6885
6886 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6887 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6888 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6889 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6890 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6891 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6892 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6893
6894 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6895 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6896
6897 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6898 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6899 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6900 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6901 << FromTy
6902 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6903 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006904 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006905 return;
6906 }
6907
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006908 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00006909 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006910 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6911 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6912 << FromTy
6913 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
6914 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6915 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6916 return;
6917 }
6918
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00006919 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
6920 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
6921 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6922 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6923 << FromTy
6924 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
6925 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6926 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
6927 return;
6928 }
6929
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006930 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6931 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6932
6933 if (isObjectArgument) {
6934 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6935 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6936 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6937 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6938 } else {
6939 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6940 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6941 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6942 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6943 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006944 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006945 return;
6946 }
6947
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006948 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6949 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6950 // the failure.
6951 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6952 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6953 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6954 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6955 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6956 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6957 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6958 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006959 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006960 return;
6961 }
6962
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006963 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006964 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006965 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6966 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6967 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6968 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6969 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6970 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006971 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006972 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006973 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006974 }
6975 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6976 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6977 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6978 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6979 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6980 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6981 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6982 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6983 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006984 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6985 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6986 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6987 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6988 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6989 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6990 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6991 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006992
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006993 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006994 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006995 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006996 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6997 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006998 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006999 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007000 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00007001 return;
7002 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007003
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00007004 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
7005 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
7006 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7007 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7008 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7009 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
7010 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7011 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7012 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7013 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7014 return;
7015 }
7016 }
7017
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00007018 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007019 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
7020 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
7021 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007022 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007023 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
7024 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
7025
7026 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007027 for (SmallVector<FixItHint, 1>::iterator
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007028 HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end();
7029 HI != HE; ++HI)
7030 FDiag << *HI;
7031 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
7032
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007033 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007034}
7035
7036void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7037 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
7038 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
7039
7040 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7041 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7042
7043 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007044
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00007045 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
7046 // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
7047 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
7048 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
7049 // Just don't report anything.
7050 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
7051 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
7052 return;
7053
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007054 // at least / at most / exactly
7055 unsigned mode, modeCount;
7056 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007057 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
7058 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7059 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007060 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00007061 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007062 mode = 0; // "at least"
7063 else
7064 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7065 modeCount = MinParams;
7066 } else {
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007067 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
7068 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7069 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007070 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
7071 mode = 1; // "at most"
7072 else
7073 mode = 2; // "exactly"
7074 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
7075 }
7076
7077 std::string Description;
7078 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
7079
7080 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007081 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007082 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007083 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007084}
7085
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007086/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
7087void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7088 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7089 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
7090
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007091 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007092 NamedDecl *ParamD;
7093 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
7094 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
7095 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007096 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
7097 case Sema::TDK_Success:
7098 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
7099
7100 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007101 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
7102 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
7103 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007104 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007105 return;
7106 }
7107
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007108 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
7109 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
7110 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
7111
7112 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
7113
7114 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
7115 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007116 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007117 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00007118 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007119 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
7120
7121 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
7122 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
7123 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
7124 // done on dependent types).
7125 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
7126
7127 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
7128 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007129 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00007130 return;
7131 }
7132
7133 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007134 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007135 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007136 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007137 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007138 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007139 which = 1;
7140 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007141 which = 2;
7142 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007143
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007144 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007145 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007146 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
7147 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007148 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00007149 return;
7150 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007151
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007152 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007153 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007154 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007155 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007156 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
7157 << ParamD->getDeclName();
7158 else {
7159 int index = 0;
7160 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
7161 index = TTP->getIndex();
7162 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
7163 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
7164 index = NTTP->getIndex();
7165 else
7166 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007167 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007168 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
7169 << (index + 1);
7170 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007171 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00007172 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007173
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00007174 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7175 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7176 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
7177 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007178
7179 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7180 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007181 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007182 return;
7183
7184 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
7185 std::string ArgString;
7186 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
7187 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
7188 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7189 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
7190 *Args);
7191 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
7192 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007193 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00007194 return;
7195 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007196
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007197 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
7198 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007199 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007200 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
7201 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007202 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007203 return;
7204 }
7205}
7206
7207/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
7208/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
7209///
7210/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
7211/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
7212/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
7213/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
7214/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
7215/// overload.
7216///
7217/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
7218/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
7219/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007220void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7221 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007222 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7223
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007224 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00007225 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
7226 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007227 std::string FnDesc;
7228 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00007229
7230 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007231 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007232 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007233 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007234 }
7235
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007236 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
7237 if (Cand->Viable) {
7238 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
7239 return;
7240 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007241
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007242 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
7243 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
7244 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
7245 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007246
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007247 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00007248 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
7249
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007250 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
7251 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00007252 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007253 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007254
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007255 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
7256 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
7257 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007258 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
7259 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007260
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00007261 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
7262 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
7263 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
7264 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00007265 }
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007266 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007267}
7268
7269void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7270 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
7271 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
7272 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
7273 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
7274 bool isLValueReference = false;
7275 bool isRValueReference = false;
7276 bool isPointer = false;
7277 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7278 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
7279 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7280 isLValueReference = true;
7281 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7282 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
7283 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7284 isRValueReference = true;
7285 }
7286 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7287 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7288 isPointer = true;
7289 }
7290 // Desugar down to a function type.
7291 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
7292 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
7293 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
7294 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
7295 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
7296
7297 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
7298 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00007299 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007300}
7301
7302void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
7303 const char *Opc,
7304 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7305 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7306 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
7307 std::string TypeStr("operator");
7308 TypeStr += Opc;
7309 TypeStr += "(";
7310 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
7311 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
7312 TypeStr += ")";
7313 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7314 } else {
7315 TypeStr += ", ";
7316 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
7317 TypeStr += ")";
7318 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7319 }
7320}
7321
7322void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7323 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7324 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
7325 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
7326 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007327 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
7328 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
7329
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007330 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007331 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007332 }
7333}
7334
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007335SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7336 if (Cand->Function)
7337 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00007338 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007339 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
7340 return SourceLocation();
7341}
7342
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007343struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
7344 Sema &S;
7345 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007346
7347 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
7348 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00007349 // Fast-path this check.
7350 if (L == R) return false;
7351
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007352 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007353 if (L->Viable) {
7354 if (!R->Viable) return true;
7355
7356 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
7357 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
7358 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007359 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
7360 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007361 } else if (R->Viable)
7362 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007363
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007364 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007365
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007366 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
7367 if (!L->Viable) {
7368 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
7369 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7370 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7371 return false;
7372 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7373 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7374 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007375
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007376 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
7377 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
7378 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
7379 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7380 return true;
7381
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007382 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
7383 // comes first.
7384 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7385 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7386 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
7387 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00007388 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007389 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
7390 return true;
7391 else
7392 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00007393 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007394
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007395 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
7396 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
7397 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
7398
7399 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00007400 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
7401 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007402 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7403 L->Conversions[I],
7404 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007405 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7406 leftBetter++;
7407 break;
7408
7409 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7410 leftBetter--;
7411 break;
7412
7413 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7414 break;
7415 }
7416 }
7417 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
7418 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
7419
7420 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7421 return false;
7422
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00007423 // TODO: others?
7424 }
7425
7426 // Sort everything else by location.
7427 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
7428 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
7429
7430 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
7431 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
7432 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
7433
7434 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007435 }
7436};
7437
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007438/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007439/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007440void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7441 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7442 assert(!Cand->Viable);
7443
7444 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7445 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7446
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007447 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
7448 bool Unfixable = false;
7449
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007450 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007451 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007452 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7453 while (true) {
7454 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7455 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007456 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
7457 if ((Unfixable = !TryToFixBadConversion(S, Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1],
7458 Cand->Fix)))
7459 Cand->Fix.Hints.clear();
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007460 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007461 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007462 }
7463
7464 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7465 return;
7466
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007467 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7468 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7469
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007470 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007471 // operation somehow.
7472 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007473
7474 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7475 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7476
7477 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7478 QualType ConvType
7479 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7480 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7481 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7482 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7483 ArgIdx--;
7484 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7485 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7486 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7487 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7488 ArgIdx--;
7489 } else {
7490 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7491 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7492 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7493 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007494 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7495 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007496 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007497 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
7498 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7499 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007500 return;
7501 }
7502
7503 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7504 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7505 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007506 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007507 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007508 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007509 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007510 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7511 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7512 S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007513 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
7514 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7515 Unfixable = !TryToFixBadConversion(S, Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx],
7516 Cand->Fix);
7517 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007518 else
7519 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7520 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00007521
7522 if (Unfixable) {
7523 Cand->Fix.Hints.clear();
7524 Cand->Fix.NumConversionsFixed = 0;
7525 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007526}
7527
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007528} // end anonymous namespace
7529
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007530/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7531/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007532/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007533void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7534 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7535 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7536 const char *Opc,
7537 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007538 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7539 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007540 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007541 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7542 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007543 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007544 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007545 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007546 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007547 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7548 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7549 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7550 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007551 }
7552 }
7553
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007554 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007555 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007556
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007557 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007558
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007559 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007560 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007561 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007562 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7563 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007564
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007565 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7566 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7567 // candidate list.
7568 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7569 break;
7570 }
7571 ++CandsShown;
7572
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007573 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007574 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007575 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007576 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007577 else {
7578 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7579 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007580 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7581 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7582 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7583 //
7584 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7585 // different ambiguities, though.
7586 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007587 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007588 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7589 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007590
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007591 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007592 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007593 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007594 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007595
7596 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007597 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007598}
7599
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007600// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7601// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7602// R (A) --> R(A)
7603// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7604// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7605// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7606QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7607 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7608 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7609 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7610 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7611 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7612 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7613 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007614 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007615 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7616 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7617 Ret =
7618 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7619 return Ret;
7620}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007621
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007622// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7623// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7624class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7625{
7626 Sema& S;
7627 Expr* SourceExpr;
7628 const QualType& TargetType;
7629 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7630
7631 bool Complain;
7632 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7633 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007634
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007635 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7636 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007637
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007638 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7639 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7640 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007641 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007642
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007643public:
7644 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7645 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7646 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7647 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7648 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7649 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7650 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7651 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7652 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7653 {
7654 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7655
7656 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7657 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7658 DeclAccessPair dap;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007659 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007660 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007661
7662 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7663 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7664 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7665 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7666 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7667 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7668
7669 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7670 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7671 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7672 return;
7673 }
7674 }
7675
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007676 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7677 }
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007678 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007679 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007680 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007681
7682 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7683 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007684
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007685 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7686 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7687 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7688 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7689 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7690 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7691 else
7692 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7693 }
7694 }
7695 }
7696
7697private:
7698 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7699 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7700 }
7701
7702 // [ToType] [Return]
7703
7704 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7705 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7706 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7707 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7708 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7709 }
7710
7711 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7712 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7713 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7714 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7715 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7716 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7717 // static when converting to member pointer.
7718 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7719 return false;
7720 }
7721 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7722 return false;
7723
7724 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7725 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7726 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7727 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7728 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7729 // overloaded functions considered.
7730 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7731 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7732 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7733 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7734 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7735 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7736 Info)) {
7737 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7738 (void)Result;
7739 return false;
7740 }
7741
7742 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7743 // This function template specicalization works.
7744 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7745 assert(TargetFunctionType
7746 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7747 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7748 return true;
7749 }
7750
7751 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7752 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007753 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007754 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7755 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007756 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7757 return false;
7758 }
7759 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7760 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007761
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007762 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007763 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007764 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7765 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00007766 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
7767 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007768 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7769 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007770 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007771 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007772 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007773 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007774
7775 return false;
7776 }
7777
7778 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7779 bool Ret = false;
7780
7781 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7782 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7783 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7784 return false;
7785
7786 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7787 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7788 I != E; ++I) {
7789 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7790 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7791
7792 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7793 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7794 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7795 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7796 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7797 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7798 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7799 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7800 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7801 Ret = true;
7802 }
7803 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7804 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7805 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7806 Ret = true;
7807 }
7808 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7809 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007810 }
7811
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007812 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007813 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7814 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7815 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7816 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7817 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7818
7819 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7820 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7821 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7822 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007823
7824 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7825 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7826 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007827
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007828 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007829 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7830 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7831 S.PDiag(),
7832 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7833 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7834 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7835 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7836 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007837
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007838 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7839 // Make it the first and only element
7840 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7841 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7842 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007843 }
7844 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007845
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007846 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7847 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7848 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7849 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7850 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7851 ++I;
7852 else {
7853 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7854 Matches.set_size(N);
7855 }
7856 }
7857 }
7858
7859public:
7860 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7861 assert(Matches.empty());
7862 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7863 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7864 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7865 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7866 }
7867
7868 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7869 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7870 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7871 }
7872
7873 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7874 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7875 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7876 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7877 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7878 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7879 }
7880
7881 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7882 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7883 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7884 }
7885
7886 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7887 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7888 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7889 << OvlExpr->getName()
7890 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7891 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7892 }
7893
7894 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7895
7896 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7897 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7898 return Matches[0].second;
7899 }
7900
7901 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7902 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7903 return &Matches[0].first;
7904 }
7905};
7906
7907/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7908/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7909/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7910/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7911///
7912/// @code
7913/// int f(double);
7914/// int f(int);
7915///
7916/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7917/// @endcode
7918///
7919/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7920/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7921/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7922FunctionDecl *
7923Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7924 bool Complain,
7925 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7926
7927 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7928
7929 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7930 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7931 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7932 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7933 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7934 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7935 else
7936 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7937 }
7938 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7939 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7940 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7941 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7942 assert(Fn);
7943 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7944 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007945 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007946 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007947 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007948
7949 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007950}
7951
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007952/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007953/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7954///
7955/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7956/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007957/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007958/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007959FunctionDecl *
7960Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
7961 bool Complain,
7962 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007963 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7964 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7965 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007966 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7967 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7968 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007969
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007970 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007971 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007972 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007973
7974 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007975 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007976
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007977 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7978 // whose type matches exactly.
7979 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007980 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
7981 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007982 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7983 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007984 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7985 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7986 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007987 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007988 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7989 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007990
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007991 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7992 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7993 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7994 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7995 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7996 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007997 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00007998 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007999 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
8000 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8001 Specialization, Info)) {
8002 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8003 (void)Result;
8004 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008005 }
8006
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008007 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
8008
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008009 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008010 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008011 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008012 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8013 << ovl->getName();
8014 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008015 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008016 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008017 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008018
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008019 Matched = Specialization;
8020 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008021 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008022
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00008023 return Matched;
8024}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008025
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008026
8027
8028
8029// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
8030// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
8031// template specialization
8032// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
8033ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008034 Expr *SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, bool complain,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008035 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
8036 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008037 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
8038 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008039
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008040 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008041
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008042 DeclAccessPair found;
8043 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
8044 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8045 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
8046 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin()))
8047 return ExprError();
8048
8049 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
8050 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
8051 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
8052 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
8053 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
8054 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
8055 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
8056 if (complain) {
8057 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
8058 diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8059 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
8060 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
8061 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
8062 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
8063 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
8064 // the static candidates were rejected.
8065 }
8066
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00008067 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008068 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00008069
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00008070 // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
8071 SingleFunctionExpression =
8072 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr, found, fn));
8073
8074 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
8075 if (doFunctionPointerConverion)
8076 SingleFunctionExpression =
8077 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
8078 }
8079
8080 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
8081 if (complain) {
8082 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
8083 << ovl.Expression->getName()
8084 << DestTypeForComplaining
8085 << OpRangeForComplaining
8086 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
8087 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
8088 }
8089 return ExprError();
8090 }
8091
8092 return SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00008093}
8094
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008095/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
8096static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008097 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008098 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008099 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8100 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008101 bool PartialOverloading,
8102 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008103 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008104 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
8105 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
8106
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008107 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008108 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
8109 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
8110 return;
8111 }
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008112 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorc27d6c52010-04-16 17:41:49 +00008113 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008114 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008115 }
8116
8117 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
8118 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008119 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
8120 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008121 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008122 return;
8123 }
8124
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008125 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008126}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008127
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008128/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
8129/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008130void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008131 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8132 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
8133 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008134
8135#ifndef NDEBUG
8136 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
8137 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008138 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008139 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
8140 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
8141 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
8142 //
8143 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
8144 //
8145 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008146 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008147 //
8148 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
8149 // template
8150 //
8151 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008152
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008153 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8154 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8155 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8156 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
8157 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
8158 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
8159 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008160 }
8161 }
8162#endif
8163
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008164 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
8165 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00008166 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008167 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8168 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8169 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8170 }
8171
8172 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8173 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008174 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008175 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008176 PartialOverloading, /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008177
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008178 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008179 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
8180 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008181 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008182 CandidateSet,
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00008183 PartialOverloading,
8184 ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00008185}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008186
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008187/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
8188/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
8189/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
8190/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
8191///
8192/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8193static bool
8194DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
8195 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
8196 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8197 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8198 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
8199 return false;
8200
8201 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
8202 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
8203
8204 if (!R.empty()) {
8205 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8206
8207 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
8208 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
8209 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
8210 R.clear();
8211 return false;
8212 }
8213
8214 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
8215 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
8216 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
8217 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008218 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008219
8220 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008221 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008222 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
8223 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008224 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008225 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00008226 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008227
8228 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
8229 // declaring the function there instead.
8230 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
8231 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
8232 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, NumArgs,
8233 AssociatedNamespaces,
8234 AssociatedClasses);
8235 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008236 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008237 if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008238 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
8239 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008240 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
8241 if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
8242 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
8243 }
Chandler Carruth45cad4a2011-06-08 10:13:17 +00008244 } else {
8245 // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
8246 SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008247 }
8248
8249 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8250 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008251 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008252 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8253 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8254 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008255 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008256 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8257 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +00008258 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008259 } else {
8260 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
8261 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
8262 // a localized representation of a list of items.
8263 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8264 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8265 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
8266 }
8267
8268 // Try to recover by calling this function.
8269 return true;
8270 }
8271
8272 R.clear();
8273 }
8274
8275 return false;
8276}
8277
8278/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
8279/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
8280/// was defined.
8281///
8282/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8283static bool
8284DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8285 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8286 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8287 DeclarationName OpName =
8288 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8289 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
8290 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
8291 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args, NumArgs);
8292}
8293
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008294/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
8295///
8296/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008297static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008298BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008299 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
8300 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8301 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008302 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8303 bool EmptyLookup) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008304
8305 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008306 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008307
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008308 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008309 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008310 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8311 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8312 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8313 }
8314
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008315 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
8316 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008317 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
8318 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs) &&
8319 (!EmptyLookup ||
8320 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008321 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008322
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008323 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
8324
8325 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
8326 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008327 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008328 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008329 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
8330 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008331 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8332 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
8333 else
8334 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
8335
8336 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008337 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008338
8339 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008340 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008341 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008342 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008343 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008344}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +00008345
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008346/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00008347/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
8348/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
8349/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
8350/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregor0a396682008-11-26 06:01:48 +00008351/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008352/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008353ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008354Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008355 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8356 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00008357 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8358 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008359#ifndef NDEBUG
8360 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8361 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
8362 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
8363
8364 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
8365 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
8366 FunctionDecl *F;
8367 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
8368 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
8369 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
8370 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008371
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008372 // We don't perform ADL in C.
8373 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithad762fc2011-04-14 22:09:26 +00008374 } else
8375 assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
8376 "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008377#endif
8378
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008379 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00008380
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008381 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
8382 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
8383 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008384
8385 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008386 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
8387 // out if it fails.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008388 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00008389 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008390 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00008391
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008392 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008393 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008394 case OR_Success: {
8395 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008396 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008397 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008398 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
8399 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008400 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbournee08ce652011-02-09 21:07:24 +00008401 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8402 ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008403 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008404
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008405 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8406 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
8407 // have meant to call.
8408 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
8409 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8410 /*EmptyLookup=*/false);
8411 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
8412 return Recovery;
8413
Chris Lattner4330d652009-02-17 07:29:20 +00008414 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008415 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008416 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008417 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008418 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008419 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008420
8421 case OR_Ambiguous:
8422 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008423 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008424 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008425 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008426
8427 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanian2b982b72011-02-25 18:38:59 +00008428 {
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008429 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
8430 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8431 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008432 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008433 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanian2b982b72011-02-25 18:38:59 +00008434 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8435 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008436 break;
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008437 }
8438
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008439 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00008440 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +00008441}
8442
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008443static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00008444 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
8445 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
8446}
8447
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008448/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8449/// operator.
8450///
8451/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
8452///
8453/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8454/// operator.
8455///
8456/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8457/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8458/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8459/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8460/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8461/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
8462///
8463/// \param input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008464ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008465Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
8466 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008467 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008468 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008469
8470 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8471 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
8472 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008473 // TODO: provide better source location info.
8474 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008475
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008476 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8477 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
8478 if (Result.isInvalid())
8479 return ExprError();
8480 Input = Result.take();
8481 }
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008482
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008483 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
8484 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008485
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008486 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
8487 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
8488 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008489 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008490 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00008491 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
8492 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008493 NumArgs = 2;
8494 }
8495
8496 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008497 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008498 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008499 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008500 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008501 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +00008502 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008503
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008504 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008505 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008506 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008507 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008508 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
8509 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008510 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008511 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008512 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008513 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008514 OpLoc));
8515 }
8516
8517 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008518 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008519
8520 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008521 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008522
8523 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8524 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8525
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008526 // Add candidates from ADL.
8527 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregordc81c882010-02-05 05:15:43 +00008528 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008529 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8530 CandidateSet);
8531
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008532 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008533 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008534
8535 // Perform overload resolution.
8536 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008537 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008538 case OR_Success: {
8539 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8540 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008541
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008542 if (FnDecl) {
8543 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8544 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008545
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008546 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8547
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008548 // Convert the arguments.
8549 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008550 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008551
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008552 ExprResult InputRes =
8553 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8554 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8555 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008556 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008557 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008558 } else {
8559 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008560 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008561 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008562 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00008563 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008564 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008565 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +00008566 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008567 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008568 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008569 }
8570
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008571 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8572
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008573 // Determine the result type.
8574 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8575 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8576 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008577
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008578 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008579 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
8580 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8581 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008582
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +00008583 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008584 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008585 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008586 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008587
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008588 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +00008589 FnDecl))
8590 return ExprError();
8591
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008592 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008593 } else {
8594 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8595 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8596 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008597 ExprResult InputRes =
8598 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8599 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8600 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8601 return ExprError();
8602 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008603 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008604 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008605 }
8606
8607 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008608 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
8609 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
8610 // defined too late to be candidates.
8611 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, NumArgs))
8612 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
8613 return ExprError();
8614
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008615 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
8616 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8617 break;
8618
8619 case OR_Ambiguous:
8620 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8621 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8622 << Input->getType()
8623 << Input->getSourceRange();
8624 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
8625 Args, NumArgs,
8626 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8627 return ExprError();
8628
8629 case OR_Deleted:
8630 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8631 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8632 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8633 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8634 << Input->getSourceRange();
8635 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8636 return ExprError();
8637 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008638
8639 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8640 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8641 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008642 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008643}
8644
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008645/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8646/// operator.
8647///
8648/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8649///
8650/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8651/// operator.
8652///
8653/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8654/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8655/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8656/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8657/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8658/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8659///
8660/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8661/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008662ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008663Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008664 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008665 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008666 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008667 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008668 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008669
8670 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8671 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8672 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8673
8674 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8675 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008676 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008677 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008678 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008679 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008680 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008681 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008682 Context.DependentTy,
8683 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8684 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008685
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008686 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8687 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008688 VK_LValue,
8689 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008690 Context.DependentTy,
8691 Context.DependentTy,
8692 OpLoc));
8693 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008694
8695 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008696 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008697 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8698 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008699 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008700 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8701 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8702 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008703 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008704 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008705 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008706 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008707 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008708 OpLoc));
8709 }
8710
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008711 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008712 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8713 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8714 if (Result.isInvalid())
8715 return ExprError();
8716 Args[1] = Result.take();
8717 }
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008718
8719 // The LHS is more complicated.
8720 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8721
8722 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8723 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8724 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8725 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8726
8727 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8728 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8729 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8730
8731 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8732 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8733 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8734 // load and hope.
8735 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8736 // we really should use the primitive.
8737 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8738 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8739 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8740 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8741 if (Settable)
8742 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8743 }
8744
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008745 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8746 if (Result.isInvalid())
8747 return ExprError();
8748 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008749 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008750
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008751 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8752 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8753 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8754 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8755 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8756 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008757 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008758 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008759
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008760 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8761 // create a built-in binary operator.
8762 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8763 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8764
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008765 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008766 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008767
8768 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008769 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008770
8771 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8772 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8773
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008774 // Add candidates from ADL.
8775 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8776 Args, 2,
8777 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8778 CandidateSet);
8779
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008780 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008781 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008782
8783 // Perform overload resolution.
8784 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008785 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008786 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008787 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8788 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8789
8790 if (FnDecl) {
8791 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8792 // operator.
8793
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008794 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8795
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008796 // Convert the arguments.
8797 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008798 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008799 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008800
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008801 ExprResult Arg1 =
8802 PerformCopyInitialization(
8803 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8804 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8805 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008806 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008807 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008808
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008809 ExprResult Arg0 =
8810 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8811 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8812 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008813 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008814 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008815 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008816 } else {
8817 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008818 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8819 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8820 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8821 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008822 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008823 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008824
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008825 ExprResult Arg1 =
8826 PerformCopyInitialization(
8827 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8828 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8829 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008830 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8831 return ExprError();
8832 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8833 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008834 }
8835
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008836 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8837
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008838 // Determine the result type.
8839 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8840 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8841 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008842
8843 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008844 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8845 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8846 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008847
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008848 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008849 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008850 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008851
8852 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008853 FnDecl))
8854 return ExprError();
8855
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008856 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008857 } else {
8858 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8859 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8860 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008861 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8862 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8863 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8864 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008865 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008866 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008867
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008868 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8869 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8870 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8871 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8872 return ExprError();
8873 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008874 break;
8875 }
8876 }
8877
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008878 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8879 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8880 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8881 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8882 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008883 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008884 break;
8885
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008886 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8887 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8888 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008889 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008890 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008891 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008892 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8893 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008894 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008895 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +00008896 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
8897 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
8898 // defined too late to be candidates.
8899 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, 2))
8900 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
8901 return ExprError();
8902
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008903 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8904 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8905 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008906 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008907 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008908 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8909 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008910 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8911 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008912 return move(Result);
8913 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008914
8915 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008916 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008917 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008918 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008919 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008920 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8921 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008922 return ExprError();
8923
8924 case OR_Deleted:
8925 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8926 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8927 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008928 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008929 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008930 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008931 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008932 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008933
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008934 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008935 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008936}
8937
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008938ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008939Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8940 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008941 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8942 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008943 DeclarationName OpName =
8944 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8945
8946 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8947 // expression.
8948 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8949
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008950 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008951 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8952 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8953 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008954 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008955 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008956 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008957 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8958 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8959 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008960 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008961
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008962 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8963 Args, 2,
8964 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008965 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008966 RLoc));
8967 }
8968
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008969 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8970 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8971 if (Result.isInvalid())
8972 return ExprError();
8973 Args[0] = Result.take();
8974 }
8975 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8976 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8977 if (Result.isInvalid())
8978 return ExprError();
8979 Args[1] = Result.take();
8980 }
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008981
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008982 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008983 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008984
8985 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
8986
8987 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8988 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8989
8990 // Add builtin operator candidates.
8991 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8992
8993 // Perform overload resolution.
8994 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008995 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008996 case OR_Success: {
8997 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8998 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8999
9000 if (FnDecl) {
9001 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9002 // operator.
9003
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009004 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
9005
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009006 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009007 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009008
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009009 // Convert the arguments.
9010 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009011 ExprResult Arg0 =
9012 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9013 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9014 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009015 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009016 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009017
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009018 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009019 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009020 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009021 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009022 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009023 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00009024 Owned(Args[1]));
9025 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
9026 return ExprError();
9027
9028 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
9029
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009030 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009031 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9032 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9033 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009034
9035 // Build the actual expression node.
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +00009036 DeclarationNameLoc LocInfo;
9037 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = LLoc.getRawEncoding();
9038 LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = RLoc.getRawEncoding();
9039 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc, LocInfo);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009040 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9041 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009042
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009043 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9044 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009045 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009046 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009047
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009048 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009049 FnDecl))
9050 return ExprError();
9051
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009052 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009053 } else {
9054 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9055 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9056 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009057 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9058 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9059 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9060 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009061 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009062 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
9063
9064 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9065 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9066 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9067 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9068 return ExprError();
9069 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009070
9071 break;
9072 }
9073 }
9074
9075 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009076 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9077 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9078 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
9079 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9080 else
9081 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
9082 << Args[0]->getType()
9083 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009084 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9085 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009086 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009087 }
9088
9089 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009090 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009091 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009092 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
9093 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009094 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
9095 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009096 return ExprError();
9097
9098 case OR_Deleted:
9099 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9100 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009101 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009102 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009103 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9104 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009105 return ExprError();
9106 }
9107
9108 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009109 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00009110}
9111
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009112/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
9113/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
9114/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
9115/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
9116/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009117/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
9118/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009119ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009120Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
9121 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009122 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009123 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
9124 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
9125
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009126 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
9127 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009128 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009129
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009130 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
9131 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9132 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
9133 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
9134
9135 QualType fnType =
9136 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9137
9138 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9139 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
9140 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
9141
9142 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
9143 // member function we're calling.
9144 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
9145
9146 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
9147 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
9148 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9149 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
9150
9151 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
9152 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
9153 difference.removeAddressSpace();
9154 if (difference) {
9155 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
9156 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
9157 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
9158 << qualsString
9159 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
9160 }
9161
9162 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
9163 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
9164 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
9165
9166 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
9167 op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9168 call, 0))
9169 return ExprError();
9170
9171 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
9172 return ExprError();
9173
9174 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
9175 }
9176
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009177 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009178 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +00009179 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009180 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009181 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9182 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009183 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009184 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009185 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009186 } else {
9187 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00009188 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009189
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009190 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009191 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
9192 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
9193 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009194
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009195 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009196 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009197
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009198 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9199 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9200 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9201 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9202 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9203 }
9204
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009205 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
9206 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9207
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009208 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
9209 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
9210 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
9211 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
9212
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009213
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +00009214 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
9215 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
9216 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
9217 CandidateSet);
9218 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +00009219 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
9220 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009221 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +00009222 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009223
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009224 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009225 ObjectClassification,
9226 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009227 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009228 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009229 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009230 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009231 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009232 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00009233 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009234 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00009235 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009236
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009237 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
9238
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009239 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009240 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00009241 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009242 case OR_Success:
9243 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009244 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009245 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009246 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009247 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009248 break;
9249
9250 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009251 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009252 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00009253 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009254 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009255 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009256 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009257
9258 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009259 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00009260 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009261 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009262 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009263 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009264
9265 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009266 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009267 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009268 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009269 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009270 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009271 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009272 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009273 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009274 }
9275
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009276 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009277
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009278 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
9279 // non-member call based on that function.
9280 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9281 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
9282 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
9283 }
9284
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009285 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009286 }
9287
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009288 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
9289 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
9290 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9291
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009292 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009293 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009294 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009295 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009296
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +00009297 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009298 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009299 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009300 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009301
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009302 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009303 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
9304 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009305 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9306 ExprResult ObjectArg =
9307 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
9308 FoundDecl, Method);
9309 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
9310 return ExprError();
9311 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
9312 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009313
9314 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009315 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9316 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009317 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009318 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009319 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009320
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009321 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009322 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +00009323
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009324 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
9325 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
9326 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
9327 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
9328
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +00009329 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009330 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
9331 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
9332 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
9333 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
9334
9335 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +00009336 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +00009337 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009338 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00009339}
9340
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009341/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
9342/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
9343/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
9344/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00009345ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009346Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +00009347 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009348 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009349 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009350 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
9351 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9352 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
9353 if (Object.isInvalid())
9354 return ExprError();
9355 }
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009356
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009357 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
9358 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009359
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009360 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
9361 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +00009362 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009363 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
9364 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
9365 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
9366 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009367 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00009368 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009369
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009370 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00009371 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009372 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009373 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009374
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009375 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9376 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
9377 R.suppressDiagnostics();
9378
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00009379 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +00009380 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009381 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
9382 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00009383 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +00009384 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009385
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009386 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009387 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
9388 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009389 //
9390 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
9391 //
9392 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
9393 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +00009394 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
9395 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
9396 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
9397 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009398 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
9399 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
9400 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
9401 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
9402 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00009403 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +00009404 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCalleec51cf2010-01-20 00:46:10 +00009405 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009406 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009407 NamedDecl *D = *I;
9408 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
9409 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
9410 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009411
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +00009412 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
9413 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009414 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +00009415 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009416
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009417 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009418 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
9419 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
9420 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
9421 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9422 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9423 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009424
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +00009425 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9426 {
9427 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
9428 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9429 }
9430 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009431 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009432
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009433 // Perform overload resolution.
9434 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009435 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009436 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009437 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009438 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
9439 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009440 break;
9441
9442 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009443 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009444 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9445 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
9446 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009447 else
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009448 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +00009449 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009450 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009451 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009452 break;
9453
9454 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009455 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009456 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009457 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009458 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009459 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009460
9461 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009462 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009463 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
9464 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009465 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009466 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009467 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009468 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009469 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009470 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009471
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00009472 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009473 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009474
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009475 if (Best->Function == 0) {
9476 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
9477 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009478 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009479 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
9480 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
9481
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009482 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009483 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +00009484
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009485 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
9486 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
9487 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009488
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +00009489 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +00009490 // and then call it.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009491 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00009492 if (Call.isInvalid())
9493 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009494
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +00009495 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00009496 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009497 }
9498
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009499 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009500 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009501 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +00009502
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00009503 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
9504 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
9505 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
9506 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009507 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9508 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009509
9510 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
9511 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
9512
9513 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
9514 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
9515 // list).
9516 Expr **MethodArgs;
9517 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
9518 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9519 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
9520 } else {
9521 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
9522 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009523 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009524 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
9525 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009526
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009527 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9528 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
9529 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009530
9531 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
9532 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009533 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9534 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9535 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9536
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009537 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009538 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009539 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009540 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009541 delete [] MethodArgs;
9542
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009543 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +00009544 Method))
9545 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009546
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009547 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
9548 // slots in the call for them.
9549 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00009550 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009551 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
9552 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9553
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009554 bool IsError = false;
9555
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009556 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009557 ExprResult ObjRes =
9558 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
9559 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9560 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
9561 IsError = true;
9562 else
9563 Object = move(ObjRes);
9564 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009565
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009566 // Check the argument types.
9567 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009568 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009569 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009570 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009571
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009572 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009573
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009574 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009575 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00009576 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009577 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009578 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009579
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +00009580 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
9581 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009582 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009583 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009584 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
9585 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
9586 IsError = true;
9587 break;
9588 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009589
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00009590 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +00009591 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009592
9593 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
9594 }
9595
9596 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
9597 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
9598 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
9599 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009600 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
9601 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
9602 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009603 }
9604 }
9605
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00009606 if (IsError) return true;
9607
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009608 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00009609 return true;
9610
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +00009611 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +00009612}
9613
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009614/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009615/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009616/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009617ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009618Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009619 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9620 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009621
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009622 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9623 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
9624 if (Result.isInvalid())
9625 return ExprError();
9626 Base = Result.take();
9627 }
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +00009628
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009629 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
9630
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009631 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
9632 //
9633 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
9634 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
9635 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
9636 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00009637 DeclarationName OpName =
9638 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009639 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00009640 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009641
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00009642 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +00009643 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
9644 << Base->getSourceRange()))
9645 return ExprError();
9646
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00009647 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9648 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
9649 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +00009650
9651 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009652 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00009653 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
9654 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00009655 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009656
9657 // Perform overload resolution.
9658 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009659 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009660 case OR_Success:
9661 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
9662 break;
9663
9664 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9665 if (CandidateSet.empty())
9666 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009667 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009668 else
9669 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009670 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009671 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009672 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009673
9674 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +00009675 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9676 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009677 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009678 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00009679
9680 case OR_Deleted:
9681 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9682 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009683 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +00009684 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00009685 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009686 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009687 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009688 }
9689
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00009690 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009691 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +00009692 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009693
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009694 // Convert the object parameter.
9695 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009696 ExprResult BaseResult =
9697 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
9698 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9699 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00009700 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009701 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +00009702
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009703 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009704 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9705 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9706 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009707
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009708 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9709 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9710 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009711 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009712 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009713 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009714
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009715 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009716 Method))
9717 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009718
9719 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009720}
9721
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009722/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9723/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9724/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9725/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009726/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009727Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009728 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009729 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009730 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9731 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009732 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009733 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009734
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009735 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009736 }
9737
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009738 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009739 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9740 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009741 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009742 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009743 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009744 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009745 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009746 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009747
9748 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009749 ICE->getCastKind(),
9750 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009751 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009752 }
9753
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009754 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009755 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009756 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009757 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9758 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9759 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9760 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009761 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009762 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9763 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9764 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009765 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9766 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009767 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009768 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009769
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009770 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9771 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9772 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9773 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9774
9775 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9776 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9777 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9778 QualType ClassType
9779 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9780 QualType MemPtrType
9781 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9782
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009783 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9784 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9785 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009786 }
9787 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009788 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9789 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009790 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009791 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009792
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009793 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009794 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009795 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009796 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009797 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009798
9799 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009800 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9801 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009802 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009803 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9804 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009805 }
9806
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009807 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor40d96a62011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009808 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009809 Fn,
9810 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009811 Fn->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009812 VK_LValue,
Chandler Carruth3aa81402011-05-01 23:48:14 +00009813 Found.getDecl(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009814 TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009815 }
9816
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009817 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009818 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009819 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9820 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9821 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9822 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9823 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009824
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009825 Expr *Base;
9826
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009827 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9828 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009829 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9830 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9831 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor40d96a62011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009832 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009833 Fn,
9834 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9835 Fn->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009836 VK_LValue,
Chandler Carruth3aa81402011-05-01 23:48:14 +00009837 Found.getDecl(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009838 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009839 } else {
9840 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9841 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009842 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009843 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9844 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9845 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9846 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009847 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009848 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009849
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009850 ExprValueKind valueKind;
9851 QualType type;
9852 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9853 valueKind = VK_LValue;
9854 type = Fn->getType();
9855 } else {
9856 valueKind = VK_RValue;
9857 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
9858 }
9859
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009860 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009861 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregor40d96a62011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009862 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009863 Fn,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009864 Found,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009865 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009866 TemplateArgs,
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +00009867 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009868 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009869
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009870 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9871 return E;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009872}
9873
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009874ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009875 DeclAccessPair Found,
9876 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009877 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009878}
9879
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009880} // end namespace clang